blob: 9bc7d7150b4f0a1d3b73aab0dfb55413267b57a7 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100676. Cache
686.1. Limitation
696.2. Setup
706.2.1. Cache section
716.2.2. Proxy section
72
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200737. Using ACLs and fetching samples
747.1. ACL basics
757.1.1. Matching booleans
767.1.2. Matching integers
777.1.3. Matching strings
787.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
807.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
827.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200837.3.1. Converters
847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
857.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
867.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
877.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
887.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200897.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090
918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001169.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200117
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011810. FastCGI applications
11910.1. Setup
12010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12110.1.2. Proxy section
12210.1.3. Example
12310.2. Default parameters
12410.3. Limitations
125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126
1271. Quick reminder about HTTP
128----------------------------
129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
132on almost anything found in the contents.
133
134However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
135formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
136correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
137
138
1391.1. The HTTP transaction model
140-------------------------------
141
142The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100143to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
145connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146will involve a new connection :
147
148 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
149
150In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
151establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
152by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
153length.
154
155Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
156to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
157however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
158response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
159header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
160
161 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
162
163Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
164power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
165but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200166a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100168Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
170second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
171page :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
176latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
177correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
178the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100179server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
182time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
183are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
184parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
185carry the stream identifier.
186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
188connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
189leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
191processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
192waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200194HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100195 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
196 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100197 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100201For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
202the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100203server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
204is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
205servers.
206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
275received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
276processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
277as well as in server logs.
278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
295as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200600 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100601 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200603 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200605 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100608 - presetenv
609 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - uid
611 - ulimit-n
612 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200613 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100614 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200615 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200617 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200618 - ssl-default-bind-options
619 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200620 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200621 - ssl-default-server-options
622 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100623 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100624 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100625 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100626 - 51degrees-data-file
627 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200628 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200629 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200630 - wurfl-data-file
631 - wurfl-information-list
632 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200633 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100634 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100637 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200638 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200640 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100641 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100642 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100643 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200644 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200645 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200646 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200647 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - noepoll
649 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000650 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300653 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000654 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100655 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200656 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200657 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200658 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000659 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000660 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200661 - tune.buffers.limit
662 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200663 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200664 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100665 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200666 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200667 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200668 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100669 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200670 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200671 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100672 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100673 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100674 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100675 - tune.lua.session-timeout
676 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200677 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100678 - tune.maxaccept
679 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200680 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200681 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200682 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100683 - tune.rcvbuf.client
684 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100685 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200686 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100687 - tune.sndbuf.client
688 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100689 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100690 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200691 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100692 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200693 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200694 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100695 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200696 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100697 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200698 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
699 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
700 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100701 - tune.zlib.memlevel
702 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704 * Debugging
705 - debug
706 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707
708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710------------------------------------
711
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200712ca-base <dir>
713 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200714 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
715 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717chroot <jail dir>
718 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
719 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
720 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
721 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
722 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100724
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100725cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
726 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
727 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
728 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
729 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
730 set. These sets have the format
731
732 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
733
734 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
737 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100738 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
739 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100741 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100743 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
745 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
746 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
747 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100748
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100749 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
750 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
751 on the machine's word size.
752
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100753 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
755 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
756 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
757 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
758 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
759 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760
761 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100762 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
763
764 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
765 # first 4 CPUs
766
767 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
768 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
769 # word size.
770
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100772 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100773 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
774 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
775 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
776
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
778 # and so on.
779 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
780 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
781 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
782
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100783 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
785 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
786 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
787
788 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
790 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
791
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100792 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
793 # and a thread range.
794 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
795 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
796 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
797
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200798crt-base <dir>
799 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
800 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
801 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
802
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200803daemon
804 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
805 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100806 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
807 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200809deviceatlas-json-file <path>
810 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100811 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200812
813deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100814 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200815 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
816
817deviceatlas-separator <char>
818 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
819 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
820
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100821deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200822 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
823 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
824 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100825
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100827 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
828 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100829 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
830 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
831 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
832 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
833 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900834
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200835gid <number>
836 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
837 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
838 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100839 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
840 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100842
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100843group <group name>
844 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
845 See also "gid" and "user".
846
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100847hard-stop-after <time>
848 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
849
850 Arguments :
851 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
852 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
853 SIGUSR1 signal.
854
855 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
856 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
857 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
858
859 Example:
860 global
861 hard-stop-after 30s
862
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200863h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
864 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
865 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
866 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
867 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
868 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
869 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
870 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
871 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
872 specified in a proxy.
873
874 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
875 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
876 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
877 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
878 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
879 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
880 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
881
882 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
883 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
884 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
885 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
886 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
887
888 Example:
889 global
890 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
891
892 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
893 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
894
895h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
896 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
897 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
898 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
899 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
900 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
901 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
902 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
903 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
904
905 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
906 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
907 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
908
909 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
910 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
911
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100912insecure-fork-wanted
913 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
914 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
915 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
916 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
917 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
918 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
919 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
920 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
921 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
922 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
923 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
924 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
925 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
926 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
927 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
928 disable it.
929
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100930insecure-setuid-wanted
931 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
932 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
933 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
934 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
935 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
936 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
937 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
938 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
939 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
940 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
941 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
942 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
943 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
944 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
945
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200946log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
947 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100948 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100949 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100950 configured with "log global".
951
952 <address> can be one of:
953
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100954 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100955 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
956 port).
957
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100958 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
959 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
960 port).
961
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100962 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100963 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
964 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100965 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100966
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100967 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
968 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
969 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
970 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
971 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
972 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
973 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
974 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
975 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
976 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
977 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
978 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
979 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
980 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100981 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
982 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100983
984 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
985 "fd@2", see above.
986
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200987 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
988 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
989 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
990 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
991 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
992
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200993 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
994 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100995
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200996 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
997 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
998 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
999 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1000 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1001 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1002 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1003 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1004 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1005 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001006 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1007 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001008
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001009 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1010 one of the following :
1011
1012 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1013 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1014
1015 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1016 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1017
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001018 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1019 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1020 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1021 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1022 logger consumes.
1023
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001024 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1025 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1026 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1027 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1028
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001029 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1030 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1031 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1032 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1033 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1034
1035 <sample_size>
1036 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1037 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1038 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1039 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1040 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1041
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001042 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001044 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1045 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1046 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1047
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001048 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1049 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1050 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1051 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052
1053 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001054 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1055 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1056 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1057 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1058 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1059 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001061 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001062
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001063log-send-hostname [<string>]
1064 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1065 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1066 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1067 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1068 the logs.
1069
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001070log-tag <string>
1071 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1072 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1073 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001074 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001075
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001076lua-load <file>
1077 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1078 used multiple times.
1079
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001080master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001081 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1082 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1083 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001084 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001085 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1086 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001087 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1088 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1089 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1090 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1091 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001092
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001093 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001094
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001095mworker-max-reloads <number>
1096 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001097 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001098 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1099 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1100 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102nbproc <number>
1103 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1104 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1105 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001106 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1107 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001108 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1109 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001111nbthread <number>
1112 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001113 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1114 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1115 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1116 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1117 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001118 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1119 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1120 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1121 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1122 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1123 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1124 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001125
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001127 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1129 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1130
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001131presetenv <name> <value>
1132 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1133 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1134 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1135 and "unsetenv".
1136
1137resetenv [<name> ...]
1138 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1139 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1140 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1141 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1142 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1143 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1144 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1145 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1146
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001147stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001148 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1149 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1150 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1151 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1152 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1153 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001154 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001155 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1156 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1157 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1158 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001159
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001160server-state-base <directory>
1161 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001162 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1163 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001164
1165server-state-file <file>
1166 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1167 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1168 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1169 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1170 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1171 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1172 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1173 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001174 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1175 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001177setenv <name> <value>
1178 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1179 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1180 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1181 and "unsetenv".
1182
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001183set-dumpable
1184 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001185 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1186 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1187 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1188 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1189 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1190 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1191 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1192 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1193 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1194 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1195 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1196 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1197 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1198 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1199 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1200 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1201 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001202
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001203ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1205 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001206 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001207 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001208 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1209 information and recommendations see e.g.
1210 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1211 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1212 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1213 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001214
1215ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1216 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1217 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1218 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1219 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1220 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001221 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1222 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1223 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001224 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001225
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001226ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1228 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1229 keyword to see available options.
1230
1231 Example:
1232 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001233 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001234
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001235ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1237 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001238 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001239 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001240 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1241 information and recommendations see e.g.
1242 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1243 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1244 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1245 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1246 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001247
1248ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1250 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1251 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1252 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1253 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001254 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1255 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1256 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1257 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001258
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001259ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1261 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1262 keyword to see available options.
1263
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001264ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1266 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1267 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001269 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001270 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1271 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1272 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1273 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001274 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1275 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1276 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1277
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001278ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1279 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1280 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1281 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1282
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001283stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1284 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1285 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1286 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001287 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001288 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001289
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001290 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1291 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1292 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001293
1294stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1295 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1296 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001297 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001298
1299stats maxconn <connections>
1300 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1301 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1302
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001303uid <number>
1304 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1305 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1306 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1307 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1308
1309ulimit-n <number>
1310 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1311 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1312 option.
1313
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001314unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1315 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1316
1317 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1318 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1319 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1320 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1321 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1322 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1323 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1324 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1325 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1326 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1327
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001328unsetenv [<name> ...]
1329 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1330 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1331 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1332 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1333 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1334 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1335 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001337user <user name>
1338 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1339 See also "uid" and "group".
1340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001341node <name>
1342 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1343
1344 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1345 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1346 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1347 traffic.
1348
1349description <text>
1350 Add a text that describes the instance.
1351
1352 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1353 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1354 "<" and ">" characters.
1355
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100135651degrees-data-file <file path>
1357 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001358 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001359
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001360 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001361 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1362
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000136351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001364 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1365 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1366 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1367
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001368 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001369 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1370
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200137151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001372 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1373 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1374
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001375 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1376 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1377
137851degrees-cache-size <number>
1379 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1380 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1381 By default, this cache is disabled.
1382
1383 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001384 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1385
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386wurfl-data-file <file path>
1387 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1388 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1389
1390 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1391 with USE_WURFL=1.
1392
1393wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1394 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1395 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1396 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1397
1398 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1399
1400 Valid WURFL properties are:
1401 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1402
1403 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1404 device.
1405
1406 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1407 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1408
1409 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1410 particular web request.
1411
1412 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1413 used Libwurfl API version.
1414
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001415 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1416 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1417
1418 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1419 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1420
1421 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1422
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001423 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1424 with USE_WURFL=1.
1425
1426wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1427 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1428 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1429
1430 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1431 with USE_WURFL=1.
1432
1433wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1434 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1435 thus before the chroot.
1436
1437 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1438 with USE_WURFL=1.
1439
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001440wurfl-cache-size <size>
1441 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1442 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001443 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001444 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001445
1446 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1447 with USE_WURFL=1.
1448
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001449strict-limits
1450 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1451 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1452 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1453 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1454 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1455 keyword.
1456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001458-----------------------
1459
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001460busy-polling
1461 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1462 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1463 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1464 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1465 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1466 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1467 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1468 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1469 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1470 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1471 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1472 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1473 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1474 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1475 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1476 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1477 "poll" pollers.
1478
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001479 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1480 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1481 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1482
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001483max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1484 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1485 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1486 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1487 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1488 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1489 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1490 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1491 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001493maxconn <number>
1494 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1495 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1496 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001497 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1498 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1499 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1500 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001501 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1502 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1503 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1504 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1505 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1506 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001507
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001508maxconnrate <number>
1509 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1510 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1511 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1512 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1513 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1514 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1515 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1516 fairness.
1517
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001518maxcomprate <number>
1519 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001520 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001521 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1522 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1523 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001524 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001525 default value.
1526
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001527maxcompcpuusage <number>
1528 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1529 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1530 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1531 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1532 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1533 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1534 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1535 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1536
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001537maxpipes <number>
1538 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1539 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1540 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1541 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1542 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1543 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1544
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001545maxsessrate <number>
1546 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1547 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1548 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1549 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1550 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1551 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1552 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1553 fairness.
1554
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001555maxsslconn <number>
1556 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1557 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1558 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1559 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1560 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1561 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1562 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001563 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1564 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1565 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1566 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1567 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1568 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1569 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001570
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001571maxsslrate <number>
1572 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1573 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1574 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1575 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1576 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1577 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1578 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1579 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1580 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1581 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1582
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001583maxzlibmem <number>
1584 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1585 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1586 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001587 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1588 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1589 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1590
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001591noepoll
1592 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1593 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001594 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001595
1596nokqueue
1597 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1598 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1599 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1600
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001601noevports
1602 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1603 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1604 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1605 also "nopoll".
1606
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001607nopoll
1608 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1609 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001611 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1612 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001613
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001614nosplice
1615 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001616 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001617 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001618 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001619 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1620 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1621 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1622 "option splice-response".
1623
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001624nogetaddrinfo
1625 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1626 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1627
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001628noreuseport
1629 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1630 command line argument "-dR".
1631
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001632profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1633 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1634 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1635 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1636 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001637 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001638 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1639 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1640 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1641 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1642
1643 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1644 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1645 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1646 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1647 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001648 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1649 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1650 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1651 CLI.
1652
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001653spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001654 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1655 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1656 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1657 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1658 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1659 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001660
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001661ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001662 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001663 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001664 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1665 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1666 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1667 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1668 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001669 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1670 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001671 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1672 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1673 openssl configuration file uses:
1674 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1675
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001676ssl-mode-async
1677 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001678 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001679 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1680 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1681 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001682 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001683 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001684
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001685tune.buffers.limit <number>
1686 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1687 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1688 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1689 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1690 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001691 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001692 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1693 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1694 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1695 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1696 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1697 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1698 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1699 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1700 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1701
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001702tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1703 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1704 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1705 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1706 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1707
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001708tune.bufsize <number>
1709 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1710 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1711 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1712 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1713 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1714 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1715 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001716 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1717 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1718 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001719 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001720 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1721 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1722 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001723
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001724tune.chksize <number>
1725 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1726 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1727 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1728 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1729 checks whenever possible.
1730
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001731tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1732 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1733 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1734 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1735 this value. The default value is 1.
1736
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001737tune.fail-alloc
1738 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1739 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1740 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1741 gracefully.
1742
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001743tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1744 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1745 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1746 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1747 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1748 change it.
1749
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001750tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1751 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001752 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1753 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001754 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1755 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1756 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1757 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1758 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1759
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001760tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1761 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1762 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1763 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1764 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1765 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1766 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1767 recommended not to change this value.
1768
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001769tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1770 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1771 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1772 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1773 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1774 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1775 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1776 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1777
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001778tune.http.cookielen <number>
1779 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1780 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1781 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1782 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1783 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1784 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1785 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1786 to change this value.
1787
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001788tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001789 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1790 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001791 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001792 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001793 configuration directives too.
1794 The default value is 1024.
1795
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001796tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1797 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1798 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1799 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1800 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1801 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1802 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001803 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1804 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1805 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001806
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001807tune.idletimer <timeout>
1808 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1809 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1810 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1811 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1812 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1813 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001814 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001815 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001816 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1817
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001818tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1819 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1820 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1821 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1822 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1823 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1824 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1825 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1826 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1827 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1828
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001829tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1830 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001831 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001832 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1833 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001834 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001835 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1836 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1837
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001838tune.lua.maxmem
1839 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1840 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1841 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1842 memory.
1843
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001844tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1845 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001846 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1847 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001848 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001849
1850tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1851 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1852 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1853 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1854 check servers.
1855
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001856tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1857 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1858 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1859 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001860 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001861
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001862tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001863 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1864 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1865 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1866 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1867 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1868 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1869 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1870 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1871 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1872 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001873
1874tune.maxpollevents <number>
1875 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1876 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1877 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1878 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1879 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1880
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001881tune.maxrewrite <number>
1882 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1883 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1884 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1885 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1886 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1887 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1888 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1889 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1890 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1891 bufsize.
1892
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001893tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1894 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1895 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1896 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1897 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1898 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1899 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1900 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1901 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1902 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001903 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1904 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001905 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1906 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1907 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1908 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1909 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1910 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1911 setting this parameter to 0.
1912
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001913tune.pipesize <number>
1914 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1915 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1916 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1917 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1918 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1919 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1920
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001921tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1922 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1923 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1924 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1925 default is 20.
1926
1927tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1928 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1929 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1930 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1931 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1932 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1933 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001934 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001935
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001936tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1937tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1938 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1939 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1940 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001941 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001942 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001943 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1944 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1945
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001946tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001947 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001948 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1949 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1950 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1951 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1952
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001953tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001954 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001955 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1956 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1957
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001958tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1959tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1960 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1961 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1962 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001963 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001964 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001965 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1966 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1967 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1968 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1969 notifying haproxy again.
1970
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001971tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001972 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1973 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1974 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001975 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001976 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001977 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001978 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1979 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1980 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001981 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1982 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001983
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001984tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001985 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001986 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1987 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1988 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1989 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1990 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1991
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001992tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1993 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001994 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001995 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1996 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1997 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1998 being used for too long.
1999
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002000tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2001 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2002 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2003 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2004 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2005 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2006 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2007 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2008 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2009 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2010 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002011 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002012 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002013
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002014tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2015 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2016 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2017 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2018 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2019 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2020 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2021 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002022 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2023 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002024
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002025tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2026 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2027 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2028 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2029 1000 entries.
2030
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002031tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2032 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2033 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2034 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2035
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002036tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002037tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002038tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2039tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2040tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002041 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2042 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2043 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2044 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2045 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2046 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2047 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2048 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002049
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002050 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2051 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2052 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2053 all available space is consumed.
2054 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2055 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2056 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002057
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002058tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2059 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002060 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002061 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002062 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002063 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2064
2065tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2066 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2067 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002068 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2069 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020713.3. Debugging
2072--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002073
2074debug
2075 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2076 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2077 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2078 system startup.
2079
2080quiet
2081 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2082 line argument "-q".
2083
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020853.4. Userlists
2086--------------
2087It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2088http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2089it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2090
2091userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002092 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002093 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2094
2095group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002096 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002097 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2098 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2099
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002100user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2101 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002102 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2103 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002104 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2105 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2106 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2107 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002108
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002109 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2110 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2111 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2112 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2113 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2114 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2115 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2116 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2117 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002118
2119 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002120 userlist L1
2121 group G1 users tiger,scott
2122 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002123
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002124 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2125 user scott insecure-password elgato
2126 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002128 userlist L2
2129 group G1
2130 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002131
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002132 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2133 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2134 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002135
2136 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002137
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002138
21393.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002140----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002141It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2142several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2143instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2144values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2145automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2146In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2147using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2148tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2149reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2150Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2151that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2152each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002153
2154peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002155 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002156 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2157
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002158bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2159 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2160 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2161
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002162disabled
2163 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2164 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2165 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2166
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002167default-bind [param*]
2168 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2169
2170default-server [param*]
2171 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2172
2173 Arguments:
2174 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2175 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2176 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2177 details.
2178
2179
2180 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2181
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002182enable
2183 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2184
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002185log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2186 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2187 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2188 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2189 more details.
2190
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002191peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002192 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2193 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2194 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2195 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2196 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2197 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2198
2199 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2200 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2201
2202 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2203 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2204 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2205 across all peers.
2206
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002207 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2208 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002209
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002210 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2211 "server" keyword explanation below).
2212
2213server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002214 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002215 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2216 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2217 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2218 of this "peers" section).
2219 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2220
2221
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002222 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002223 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002224 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002225 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2226 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2227 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002228
2229 backend mybackend
2230 mode tcp
2231 balance roundrobin
2232 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2233 stick on src
2234
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002235 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2236 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002237
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002238 Example:
2239 peers mypeers
2240 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2241 default-server ssl verify none
2242 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2243 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002244
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002245
2246table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2247 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2248
2249 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2250 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002251 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002252 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2253 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2254 "stick-table" keyword).
2255
2256 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2257 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2258 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2259 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2260 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2261 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2262 of the stick-table name as follows:
2263
2264 peers mypeers
2265 peer A ...
2266 peer B ...
2267 table t1 ...
2268
2269 frontend fe1
2270 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2271
2272 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2273 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2274
2275 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2276 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2277 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2278 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2279 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2280 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2281 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2282
2283 peers mypeers
2284 peer A ...
2285 peer B ...
2286 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2287
2288 backend t1
2289 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2290
2291 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2292 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2293 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2294
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022953.6. Mailers
2296------------
2297It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2298If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2299in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2300
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002301mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002302 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2303 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2304
2305mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2306 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2307
2308 Example:
2309 mailers mymailers
2310 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2311 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2312
2313 backend mybackend
2314 mode tcp
2315 balance roundrobin
2316
2317 email-alert mailers mymailers
2318 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2319 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2320
2321 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2322 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2323
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002324timeout mail <time>
2325 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2326 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2327 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2328 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2329
2330 Example:
2331 mailers mymailers
2332 timeout mail 20s
2333 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002334
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023353.7. Programs
2336-------------
2337In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2338master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2339managed the same way as the workers.
2340
2341During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2342sequence as a worker:
2343
2344 - the master is re-executed
2345 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2346 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2347 instance of the program
2348
2349During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2350
2351program <name>
2352 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2353 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2354 the management guide).
2355
2356command <command> [arguments*]
2357 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2358 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2359 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2360 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2361
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002362user <user name>
2363 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2364 See also "group".
2365
2366group <group name>
2367 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2368 See also "user".
2369
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002370option start-on-reload
2371no option start-on-reload
2372 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2373 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2374 program section.
2375
2376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023774. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002378----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002380Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002381 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002382 - frontend <name>
2383 - backend <name>
2384 - listen <name>
2385
2386A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2387its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2388section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002390
2391A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2392connections.
2393
2394A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2395to forward incoming connections.
2396
2397A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2398parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2399
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2401'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2402case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2403
2404Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2405logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2406proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2407However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2408name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2409
2410Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2411and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002412bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002413protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2414modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2415arbitrary criteria.
2416
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002417In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2418a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002419the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002420
2421 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2422 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2423 between responses and new requests.
2424
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002425 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2426 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2427 client-facing connection remains open.
2428
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002429 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2430 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002431
2432The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2433frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2434following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002435weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002436
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002437 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002438
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002439 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2440 ----+-----+-----+----
2441 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2442 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002443 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2444 ----+-----+-----+----
2445 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024494.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2450--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002452The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2453limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2454they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2455limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002456marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002457option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002458and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2459with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2460specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002462
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002463 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2464------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2465acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002466backlog X X X -
2467balance X - X X
2468bind - X X -
2469bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470capture cookie - X X -
2471capture request header - X X -
2472capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002473compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002474cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002475declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476default-server X - X X
2477default_backend X X X -
2478description - X X X
2479disabled X X X X
2480dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002481email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002482email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002483email-alert mailers X X X X
2484email-alert myhostname X X X X
2485email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002486enabled X X X X
2487errorfile X X X X
2488errorloc X X X X
2489errorloc302 X X X X
2490-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2491errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002492force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002493filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002494fullconn X - X X
2495grace X X X X
2496hash-type X - X X
2497http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002498http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002499http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002501http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002502http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002503http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002504id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002505ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002506load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002507log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002508log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002509log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002510log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002511max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002512maxconn X X X -
2513mode X X X X
2514monitor fail - X X -
2515monitor-net X X X -
2516monitor-uri X X X -
2517option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2518option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2519option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2520option allbackups (*) X - X X
2521option checkcache (*) X - X X
2522option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2523option contstats (*) X X X -
2524option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2525option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002526-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2527option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002528option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2529option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002530option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002531option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002532option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002533option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002534option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002535option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2536option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2537option httpchk X - X X
2538option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002539option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002540option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002541option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002542option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002543option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002544option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2545option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2546option logasap (*) X X X -
2547option mysql-check X - X X
2548option nolinger (*) X X X X
2549option originalto X X X X
2550option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002551option pgsql-check X - X X
2552option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002554option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002555option smtpchk X - X X
2556option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2557option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2558option splice-request (*) X X X X
2559option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002560option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002561option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2562option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2563-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002564option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002565option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2566option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2567option tcpka X X X X
2568option tcplog X X X X
2569option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002570external-check command X - X X
2571external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2573rate-limit sessions X X X -
2574redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002575-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002576retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002577retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002578server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002579server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002580server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002581source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002582stats admin - X X X
2583stats auth X X X X
2584stats enable X X X X
2585stats hide-version X X X X
2586stats http-request - X X X
2587stats realm X X X X
2588stats refresh X X X X
2589stats scope X X X X
2590stats show-desc X X X X
2591stats show-legends X X X X
2592stats show-node X X X X
2593stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002594-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2595stick match - - X X
2596stick on - - X X
2597stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002598stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002599stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002600tcp-check connect - - X X
2601tcp-check expect - - X X
2602tcp-check send - - X X
2603tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002604tcp-request connection - X X -
2605tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002606tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002607tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002608tcp-response content - - X X
2609tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002610timeout check X - X X
2611timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002612timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002613timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002614timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2615timeout http-request X X X X
2616timeout queue X - X X
2617timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002618timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002619timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002620timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002621transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002622unique-id-format X X X -
2623unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002624use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002625use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002626use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002627------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2628 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002629
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026314.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2632---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633
2634This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2635
2636
2637acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2638 Declare or complete an access list.
2639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2640 no | yes | yes | yes
2641 Example:
2642 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2643 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2644 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002646 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002647
2648
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002649backlog <conns>
2650 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2652 yes | yes | yes | no
2653 Arguments :
2654 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2655 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002656 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002657
2658 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2659 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2660 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2661 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2662 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2663 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2664 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2665 backlog parameter.
2666
2667 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2668 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2669 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2670
2671 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2672
2673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002674balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002675balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002676 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2678 yes | no | yes | yes
2679 Arguments :
2680 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2681 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2682 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2683 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2684
2685 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2686 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2687 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2688 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002689 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002690 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002691 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2692 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2693 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2694 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2695 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2696 it, so that you don't worry.
2697
2698 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2699 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2700 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2701 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2702 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2703 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2704 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2705 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002707 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2708 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2709 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2710 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2711 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2712 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2713 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2714 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2715
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002716 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002717 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002718 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2719 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002720 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002721 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2722 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2723 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2724 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2725 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002726 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2727 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2728 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2729 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2730 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2731 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002733 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2734 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2735 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2736 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2737 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2738 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2739 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2740 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002741 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002743 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2744 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2745 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002747 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2748 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2749 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2750 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2751 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2752 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2753 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2754 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2755 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2756 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2757 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2758 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002760 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002761 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2762 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2763 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2764 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2765 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2766 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2767 URIs start with a leading "/".
2768
2769 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2770 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2771 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2772 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2773
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002774 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002775 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2776
2777 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002778 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2779 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002780 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2781 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2782 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2783 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002784 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002785 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2786 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002787
2788 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2789 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2790 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2791 server will receive the request.
2792
2793 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2794 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2795 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2796 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2797 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002798 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2799 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2800 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002801
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002802 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2803 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2804 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2805 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2806 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002808 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002809 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2810 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2811 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2812
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002813 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2814 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2815 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2816
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002817 random
2818 random(<draws>)
2819 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002820 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2821 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2822 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2823 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002824 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2825 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2826 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2827 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2828 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2829 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2830 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2831 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2832 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2833 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2834 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2835 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2836 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2837 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2838 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2839 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2840 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2841 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2842 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2843 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002844
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002845 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002846 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002847 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2848 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2849 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2850 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2851 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2852 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002853 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002854 used instead.
2855
2856 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2857 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2858 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2859 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2860
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002861 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2862 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2863 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2864
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002865 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002868 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2869 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002870
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002871 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2872 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2873 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002874
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002875 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002876 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002877 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2878 NTLM relies on.
2879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880 Examples :
2881 balance roundrobin
2882 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002883 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002884 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2885 balance hdr(host)
2886 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002887
2888 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2889 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002891 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002892 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2893 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2894 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002895 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002896
2897 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2898 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2899 defaults to 16 kB.
2900
2901 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2902 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2903
2904 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2905 Round Robin.
2906
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002907 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002908 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2909 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2910 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2911
2912 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2913
2914 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002915 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002916 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2917 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2918 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002919
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002920 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002921
2922
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002923bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2924bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2927 no | yes | yes | no
2928 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002929 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2930 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2931 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2932 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002933 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002934 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2935 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2936 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2937 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2938 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2939 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2940 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002941 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2942 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2943 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2944 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2945 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2946 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2947 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002948 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2949 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2950 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002951 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2952 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2953 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2954 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002955 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2956 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2957 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002958
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002959 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2960 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002961 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2962 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2963 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002964 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2965 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2966 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2967 the range.
2968
2969 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2970 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2971 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2972 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2973 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2974 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2975 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002976 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002977 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002979 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002980 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002981 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2982 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2983 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2984 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2985 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2986 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2987
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002988 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2989 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2990 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2991 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002992
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002993 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2994 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2995 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2996 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2997 in a frontend.
2998
2999 Example :
3000 listen http_proxy
3001 bind :80,:443
3002 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003003 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003004
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003005 listen http_https_proxy
3006 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003007 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003008
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003009 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3010 bind ipv6@:80
3011 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3012 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3013
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003014 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003015 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003016
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003017 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3018 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3019 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3020 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3021 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3022
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003023 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003024 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003025
3026
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003027bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003028 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3030 yes | yes | yes | yes
3031 Arguments :
3032 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3033 may be used to override a default value.
3034
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003035 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003036 option may be combined with other numbers.
3037
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003038 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003039 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3040 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3041 missing from all processes.
3042
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003043 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003044 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003045 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3046 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3047 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3048 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3049 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003050 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003051
3052 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3053 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3054 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3055 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3056 and 'even' instances.
3057
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003058 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3059 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3060 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3061 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003062
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003063 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3064 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3065
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003066 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3067 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3068 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3069
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003070 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3071 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3072
3073 Example :
3074 listen app_ip1
3075 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003076 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003077
3078 listen app_ip2
3079 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003080 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003081
3082 listen management
3083 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003084 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003085
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003086 listen management
3087 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3088 bind-process 1-4
3089
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003090 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003091
3092
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093capture cookie <name> len <length>
3094 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3096 no | yes | yes | no
3097 Arguments :
3098 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3099 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3100 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3101 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003102 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003103
3104 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3105 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3106 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3107 right if it exceeds <length>.
3108
3109 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3110 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3111 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3112 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3113
3114 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3115 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3116 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3117
3118 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3119 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3120 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003121 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3122 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3123 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124
3125 Example:
3126 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3127
3128 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003129 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130
3131
3132capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003133 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3135 no | yes | yes | no
3136 Arguments :
3137 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003138 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3140 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3141 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3142
3143 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3144 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3145 it exceeds <length>.
3146
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003147 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3149 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003150 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3151 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3152 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3153 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003154 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003155 environments to find where the request came from.
3156
3157 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3158 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3159 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3160 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003162 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3163 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3164 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3165 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3166 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003167
3168 Example:
3169 capture request header Host len 15
3170 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003171 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003173 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 about logging.
3175
3176
3177capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003178 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3180 no | yes | yes | no
3181 Arguments :
3182 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003183 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3185 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3186 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3187
3188 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3189 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3190 it exceeds <length>.
3191
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003192 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3194 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3195 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003196 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3197 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3198 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3199 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003201 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3202 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3203 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3204 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3205 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206
3207 Example:
3208 capture response header Content-length len 9
3209 capture response header Location len 15
3210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003211 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212 about logging.
3213
3214
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003215compression algo <algorithm> ...
3216compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003217compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003218 Enable HTTP compression.
3219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3220 yes | yes | yes | yes
3221 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003222 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3223 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3224 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3225
3226 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003227 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3228 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3229 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003230
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003231 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003232 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003233
3234 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3235 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3236 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3237 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3238 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003239 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003240
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003241 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3242 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3243 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3244 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3245 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3246 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3247 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003248 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003249
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003250 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003251 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003252 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3253 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3254 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3255 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3256 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003257
3258 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3259 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3260 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3261 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3262 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003263 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3264 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3265 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3266 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3267 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003268 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3269 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003270
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003271 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003272 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3273 "Accept-Encoding" header
3274 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003275 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003276 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3277 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3278 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3279 "multipart"
3280 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3281 header
3282 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3283 and later
3284 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3285 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003286 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003287
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003288 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003289
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003290 Examples :
3291 compression algo gzip
3292 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003293
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003294
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003295cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003296 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3297 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003298 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003299 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3301 yes | no | yes | yes
3302 Arguments :
3303 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3304 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3305 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3306 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3307 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3308 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003309 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003310 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3311 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3312
3313 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3314 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3315 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3316 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3317 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3318 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003319 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3320 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003322 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3323 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003324
3325 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003326 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003327
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003328 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003329 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003330 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003332 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3333 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3334 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3335 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3336 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3337 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3338 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003339
3340 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3341 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3342 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3343 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3344 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3345 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3346 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3347 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3348 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003349 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003350 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3351 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3352 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003353
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003354 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3355 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3356 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003357 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3358 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3359 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3360 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003361 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3362 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3363 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
3365 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3366 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3367 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3368 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3369 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3370 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3371 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3372 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3373 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3374
3375 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3376 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3377 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3378 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3379 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3380 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3381 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3382 persistence cookie in the cache.
3383 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3384
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003385 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3386 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3387 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3388 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3389 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003390 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003391 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3392 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3393 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3394 they logout.
3395
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003396 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3397 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3398 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3399 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3400
3401 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3402 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3403 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3404 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3405 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3406 this attribute.
3407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003408 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003409 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003410 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3411 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3412 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3413 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3414 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3415 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003416
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003417 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3418 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3419 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3420 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3421 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3422 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3423 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3424 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003425 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003426 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3427 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3428 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3429 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3430 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3431 the site.
3432
3433 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3434 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3435 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3436 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3437 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3438 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3439 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3440 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3441 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3442 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3443 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3444 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3445 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003447 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3448 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3449
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003450 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3451 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3452 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3453 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3454 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3455 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3456
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003457 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3458 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3459 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3460 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003462 Examples :
3463 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3464 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3465 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003466 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003467
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003468 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003469
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003470
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003471declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3472 Declares a capture slot.
3473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3474 no | yes | yes | no
3475 Arguments:
3476 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3477
3478 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3479 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3480 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3481 for use in the response.
3482
3483 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003484 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003485 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3486
3487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003488default-server [param*]
3489 Change default options for a server in a backend
3490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3491 yes | no | yes | yes
3492 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003493 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3494 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3495 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3496 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003497
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003498 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003499 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3500
3501 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003504default_backend <backend>
3505 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3507 yes | yes | yes | no
3508 Arguments :
3509 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3510
3511 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3512 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3513 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3514 will catch all undetermined requests.
3515
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003516 Example :
3517
3518 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3519 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3520 default_backend dynamic
3521
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003522 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003524
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003525description <string>
3526 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3528 no | yes | yes | yes
3529 Arguments : string
3530
3531 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3532 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3533 it describes.
3534 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3535
3536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003537disabled
3538 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3540 yes | yes | yes | yes
3541 Arguments : none
3542
3543 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3544 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3545 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3546 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3547 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3548 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3549 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3550
3551 See also : "enabled"
3552
3553
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003554dispatch <address>:<port>
3555 Set a default server address
3556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3557 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003558 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003559
3560 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3561 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3562 during start-up.
3563
3564 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3565 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3566 possible with normal servers.
3567
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003568 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003569 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3570 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3571 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3572 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3573
3574 See also : "server"
3575
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003576
3577dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3578 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 yes | no | yes | yes
3581 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3582
3583 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003584 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003585 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3586 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003587 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003588 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590enabled
3591 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3593 yes | yes | yes | yes
3594 Arguments : none
3595
3596 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3597 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3598
3599 See also : "disabled"
3600
3601
3602errorfile <code> <file>
3603 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3605 yes | yes | yes | yes
3606 Arguments :
3607 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003608 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3609 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003610
3611 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003612 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003613 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003614 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3615 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616
3617 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3618 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3619 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3620
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003621 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003623 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3624 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3625 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3626 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3627
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003628 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3629 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003630 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003631 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3632 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3633 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3636 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3637 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003638 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3640
3641 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3642
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003643 Example :
3644 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003645 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003646 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3647 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3648
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003649
3650errorloc <code> <url>
3651errorloc302 <code> <url>
3652 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | yes | yes | yes
3655 Arguments :
3656 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003657 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3658 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003659
3660 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3661 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3662 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3663 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003664 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003665
3666 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3667 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3668 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3669
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003670 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3671
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003672 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3673 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3674 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3675 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003676 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003677 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3678 request.
3679
3680 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3681
3682
3683errorloc303 <code> <url>
3684 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3686 yes | yes | yes | yes
3687 Arguments :
3688 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003689 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3690 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003691
3692 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3693 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3694 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3695 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003696 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003697
3698 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3699 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3700 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3701
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003702 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3703
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003704 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3705 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3706 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3707 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003708 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003709
3710 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3711
3712
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003713email-alert from <emailaddr>
3714 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003715 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 yes | yes | yes | yes
3718
3719 Arguments :
3720
3721 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3722
3723 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3724 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3725
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003726 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003727 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3728 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003729
3730
3731email-alert level <level>
3732 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3733 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3734 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3735 yes | yes | yes | yes
3736
3737 Arguments :
3738
3739 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3740 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3741 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3742
3743 By default level is alert
3744
3745 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3746 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3747 for the proxy.
3748
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003749 Alerts are sent when :
3750
3751 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3752 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3753 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3754 is notice or lower
3755 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3756 and a health check status update occurs
3757
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003758 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3759 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003760 section 3.6 about mailers.
3761
3762
3763email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3764 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3765 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3766 yes | yes | yes | yes
3767
3768 Arguments :
3769
3770 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3771
3772 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3773 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3774
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003775 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3776 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003777
3778
3779email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3780 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3781 mailers.
3782 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3783 yes | yes | yes | yes
3784
3785 Arguments :
3786
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003787 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003788
3789 By default the systems hostname is used.
3790
3791 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3792 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3793 for the proxy.
3794
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003795 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3796 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003797
3798
3799email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003800 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003801 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3803 yes | yes | yes | yes
3804
3805 Arguments :
3806
3807 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3808
3809 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3810 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3811
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003812 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003813 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3814
3815
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003816force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3817 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3818 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003819 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003820
3821 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3822 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3823 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3824 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3825 marked down for maintenance operations.
3826
3827 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3828 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3829 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3830 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3831 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3832 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3833 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3834 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3835 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3836
3837 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3838 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3839 is used.
3840
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003841 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003842 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003843
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003844
3845filter <name> [param*]
3846 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3848 no | yes | yes | yes
3849 Arguments :
3850 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3851 referenced in section 9.
3852
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003853 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003854 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003855 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3856 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003857
3858 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3859 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3860
3861 Example:
3862 listen
3863 bind *:80
3864
3865 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3866 filter compression
3867 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3868
3869 compression algo gzip
3870 compression offload
3871
3872 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3873
3874 See also : section 9.
3875
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003876
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003877fullconn <conns>
3878 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 yes | no | yes | yes
3881 Arguments :
3882 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3883 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3884
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003885 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003886 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003887 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003888 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3889 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3890 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3891 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3892 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003893 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003894
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003895 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3896 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003897 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3898 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3899 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003900
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003901 Example :
3902 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3903 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3904 # connections.
3905 backend dynamic
3906 fullconn 10000
3907 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3908 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3909
3910 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3911
3912
3913grace <time>
3914 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003916 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003917 Arguments :
3918 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3919 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3920 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3921
3922 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3923 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003924 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003925 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3926
3927 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3928 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3929 simplify it.
3930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003931
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003932hash-balance-factor <factor>
3933 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3935 yes | no | no | yes
3936 Arguments :
3937 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3938 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003939 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003940
3941 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3942 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3943 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3944 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3945 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3946 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3947 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3948
3949 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3950 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3951 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3952 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3953 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3954
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003955 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3956 consistent hashing mechanism.
3957
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003958 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3959
3960
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003961hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003962 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3964 yes | no | yes | yes
3965 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003966 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3967 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003968
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003969 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3970 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3971 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3972 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3973 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3974 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3975 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3976 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3977 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3978 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003979
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003980 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3981 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3982 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3983 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3984 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3985 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3986 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3987 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3988 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3989 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3990 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3991 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3992 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003993 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3994 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003995
3996 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3997
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003998 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003999 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4000 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4001 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004002 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4003 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4004 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004005
4006 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4007 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004008 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4009 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4010 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4011 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4012
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004013 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4014 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4015 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4016 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4017 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4018 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4019 parameter.
4020
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004021 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4022 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4023 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4024 used on strings.
4025
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004026 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4027
4028 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4029 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4030 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4031 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4032 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4033 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4034 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4035 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4036 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4037 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4038 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4039 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004040
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004041 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4042 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4043 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004044
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004045 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004046
4047
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004048http-check disable-on-404
4049 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004051 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004052 Arguments : none
4053
4054 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4055 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4056 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4057 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4058 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4059 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4060 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4061 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004062 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4063 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4064 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4065
4066 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4067
4068
4069http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004070 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004072 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004073 Arguments :
4074 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4075 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004076 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004077 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4078 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4079 details on the supported keywords.
4080
4081 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4082 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4083 with the usual backslash ('\').
4084
4085 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4086 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4087 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4088 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4089 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4090
4091 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004092 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004093 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4094 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4095 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4096
4097 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004098 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004099 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4100 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4101 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4102 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4103
4104 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004105 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004106 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4107 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4108 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4109 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4110 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004111 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004112 trace).
4113
4114 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004115 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004116 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4117 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4118 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4119 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4120 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004121 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004122
4123 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4124 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4125 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4126 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4127 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4128 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4129 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4130 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4131
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004132 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4133 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4134 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4135
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004136 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4137 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4138
4139 Examples :
4140 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004141 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004142
4143 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004144 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004145
4146 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004147 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004148
4149 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004150 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004151
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004152 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004153
4154
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004155http-check send-state
4156 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | no | yes | yes
4159 Arguments : none
4160
4161 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4162 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4163 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4164 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4165 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4166
4167 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4168 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4169 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4170 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4171 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004172 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4173 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4174 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4175
4176 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4177 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4178 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4179
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004180 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4181 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4182 checked in multiple backends.
4183
4184 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4185 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4186
4187 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4188 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4189 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4190 one fails.
4191
4192 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4193 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4194 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4195
4196 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4197 server's queue.
4198
4199 Example of a header received by the application server :
4200 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4201 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4202
4203 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205
4206http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004207 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4208
4209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4210 no | yes | yes | yes
4211
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004212 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4213 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4214 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4215 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4216 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004218 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4219 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004221 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223 Example:
4224 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4225 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4226 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004228 http-request allow if nagios
4229 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4230 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4231 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233 Example:
4234 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4235 acl add path /addacl
4236 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004238 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4241 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004243 Example:
4244 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4245 acl setmap path /setmap
4246 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004250 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4251 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004253 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4254 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004258 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4259 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4260 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4261 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4262 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4263 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4264 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4265 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004267http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4270 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4271 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4272 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4273 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4274 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4275 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4276 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4281 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004282
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004286 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4287 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4288 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4289 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4290 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292 Example:
4293 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4294 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004295
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004296http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004297
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004298 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4301 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004303 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4304 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4305 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4306 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4307 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4308 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4309 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4310 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4311 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4314 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4315 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4316 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4317 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4318 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4323 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4324 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4325 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4326 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4327 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004333http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4336 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4337 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4338 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4339 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4340 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004344 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4345 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4346 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4347 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4348 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004349
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004350http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4351 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4352 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4353 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4354
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004355http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4356
4357 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4358 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4359 pointed by <resolvers>.
4360 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4361 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4362 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4363 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4364 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4365 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4366 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4367 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4368 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4369 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4370 to 0.0.0.0.
4371
4372 Example:
4373 resolvers mydns
4374 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4375 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4376 timeout retry 1s
4377 hold valid 10s
4378 hold nx 3s
4379 hold other 3s
4380 hold obsolete 0s
4381 accepted_payload_size 8192
4382
4383 frontend fe
4384 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4385 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4386 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4387
4388 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4389 # which mean DNS resolution error
4390 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4391
4392 default_backend be
4393
4394 backend b_503
4395 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4396 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4397 # 503 error page to end users
4398
4399 backend be
4400 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4401 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4402 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4403 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4404 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4405
4406 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4407 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4408
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004409http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4410
4411 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4412 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4413 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4414 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004415 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4416 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004417
4418 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4423 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4424 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4425 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4426 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004428http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4431 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4432 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4433 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4436 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004437
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004438 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4439 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4440 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4441 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4442 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4443 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004444
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004445 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4446 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4447 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4448 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4449 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004450
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004451 Example:
4452 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4453
4454 # applied to:
4455 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4456
4457 # outputs:
4458 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4459
4460 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004461
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004462 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4463
4464 # applied to:
4465 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004466
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004467 # outputs:
4468 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004469
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004470http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4471 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4472
4473 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4474 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4475 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4476 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4477
4478 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4479 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4480 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4481
4482 Example:
4483 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4484 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4485
4486 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4487 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4488
4489 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4490 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4491 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4492 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4493
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004494http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4496
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004497 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4498 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4499 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4500 against.
4501
4502 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4503 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4504 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004505
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004506 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4507 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4508 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4509 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4510 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4511 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4512 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4513 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4514 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004515 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4516 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004517
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004518 Example:
4519 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4520 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004521
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004522 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4523 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004525http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4526 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004527
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004528 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4529 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4530 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4531 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004532
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004533 Example:
4534 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004535
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004536 # applied to:
4537 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004538
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004539 # outputs:
4540 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004542http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4543http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004544
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004545 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4546 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4547 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004548
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004549http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4550 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004551
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004552 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4553 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4554 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4555 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004559 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4560 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4561 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4562 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4563 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004565 Arguments:
4566 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4567 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 Example:
4570 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4571 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4574 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004576http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004578 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4579 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4580 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 Arguments:
4583 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4584 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 Example:
4587 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4588 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004590 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4591 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4592 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004594http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004596 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4597 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4598 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4599 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4600 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004602 Example:
4603 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4604 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4605 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4606 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4607 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4608 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4609 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4610 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4611 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004613http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4616 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4617 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4618 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4619 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4622 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004624 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4625 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4626 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4627 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4628 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4629 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4630 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4631 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4632 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004634http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004636 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4637 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4638 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4639 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4640 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4641 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4642 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004644http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4647 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4648 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4653 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4654 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4655 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4656 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4657 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4658 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4659 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004661http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4664 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4665 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4666 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4667 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4668 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004670 Example :
4671 # prepend the host name before the path
4672 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004676 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4677 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4678 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4679 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4680 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004682http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004684 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4685 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4686 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4687 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4688 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4689 values have higher priority.
4690 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4691 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4692 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4693 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4694 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004696http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004698 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4699 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4700 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4701 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4702 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4703 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4704 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004706 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004707
4708 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4710 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004712http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4713 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4714 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4715 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4716 privacy.
4717
4718 Arguments :
4719 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4720 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004721
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004722 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004723 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4724 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4725
4726 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4727 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4728
4729http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4730
4731 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4732 expression.
4733
4734 Arguments:
4735 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4736 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004737
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004738 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004739 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4740 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4741
4742 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4743 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4744 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4745
4746http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4747
4748 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4749 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4750 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4751 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4752 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4753 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4754 information from the request.
4755
4756 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4757
4758http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4759
4760 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4761 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4762 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4763 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4764 path and the query string.
4765 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4766
4767http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4768
4769 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4770 inline.
4771
4772 Arguments:
4773 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4774 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4775 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4776 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4777 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4778 (request and response)
4779 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4780 processing
4781 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4782 processing
4783 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4784 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4785 and '_'.
4786
4787 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4788 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004789
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004790 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004791 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004793http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4794 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004796 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4797 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4798 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4799 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4800 agent name must be used.
4801
4802 Arguments:
4803 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4804
4805 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4806 configuration.
4807
4808http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4809
4810 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4811 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4812 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4813 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4814 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4815 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4816 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4817 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4818 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4819 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4820 action.
4821 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4822 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4823 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4824 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4825 you fully understand how it works.
4826
4827http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4828
4829 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4830 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4831 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4832 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4833 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4834 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4835 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4836 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4837 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4838 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4839 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4840 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4841 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4842
4843http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4844http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4845http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4846
4847 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4848 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4849 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4850 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4851 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4852 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4853 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4854 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4855 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4856 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4857 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4858 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4859
4860 Arguments :
4861 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4862 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4863 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4864 select which table entry to update the counters.
4865
4866 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4867 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4868 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4869 that table until the session ends.
4870
4871 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4872 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4873 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4874 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4875 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4876 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4877 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4878 useful information.
4879
4880 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4881 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4882 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4883 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4884 checks that make use of it.
4885
4886http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4887
4888 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004889
4890 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004891 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004892
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004893http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4894
4895 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4896 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4897 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4898 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4899 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4900 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4901
4902 Arguments :
4903 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4904
4905 Example:
4906 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4907
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004908http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004910 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4911 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4912 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004913
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004915http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004916 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4917
4918 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4919 no | yes | yes | yes
4920
4921 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4922 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4923 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4924 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4925 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4926 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004928 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4929 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004930
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004931 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004933 Example:
4934 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004936 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004938 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4939 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004941 Example:
4942 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004946 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4947 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004949 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4950 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004952http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4955 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4956 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4957 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4958 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4959 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4960 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4961 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004963http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004965 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4966 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4967 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4968 example, or to pass some internal information.
4969 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4970 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4971 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004973http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004975 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4976 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004977
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004978http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004979
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004980 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004984 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4985 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4986 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4987 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4988 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4989 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4990 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004991
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004992 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4993 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4994 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4995 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4996 keyword.
4997 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4998 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005000http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005001
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005002 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5003 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5004 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5005 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5006 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5007 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005009http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005011 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005013http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005015 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5016 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5017 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5018 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5019 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5020 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005022http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5025 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005027http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5030 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5031 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5032 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5033 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5034 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5037 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005038
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005039 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5040 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005042 Example:
5043 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005045 # applied to:
5046 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005048 # outputs:
5049 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005053http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5054 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005055
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005056 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5057 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 Example:
5060 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 # applied to:
5063 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065 # outputs:
5066 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005068http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5069http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5072 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5073 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005074
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005075http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5076 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005077
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005078 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5079 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5080 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5081 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005083http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005085 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5086 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5087 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5088 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5089 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005091 Arguments:
5092 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005094 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5095 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005097http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005099 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5100 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5101 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5104
5105 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5106 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5107 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5108 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5109 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5110
5111http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5112
5113 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5114 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5115 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5116 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5117 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5118 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5119 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5120 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5121 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5122
5123http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5124
5125 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5126 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5127 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5128 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5129 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5130 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5131 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5132
5133http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5134
5135 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5136 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5137 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5138 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5139 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5140 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5141 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5142 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5143
5144http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5145 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5146
5147 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5148 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5149 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5150 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005151
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005152 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005153 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5154 http-response set-status 431
5155 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5156 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005158http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005160 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5161 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5162 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5163 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5164 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5165 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5166 based on some information from the request.
5167
5168 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5169
5170http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5171
5172 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5173 inline.
5174
5175 Arguments:
5176 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5177 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5178 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5179 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5180 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5181 (request and response)
5182 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5183 processing
5184 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5185 processing
5186 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5187 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5188 and '_'.
5189
5190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5191 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005192
5193 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005194 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005196http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005198 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5199 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5200 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5201 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5202 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5203 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5204 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5205 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5206 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5207 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5208 action.
5209 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5210 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5211 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5212 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5213 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005215http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5216http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5217http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005219 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5220 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5221 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5222 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5223 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5224 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5225
5226http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5227
5228 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5229 about <var-name>.
5230
5231 Example:
5232 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5233
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005234
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005235http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5236 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5237
5238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5239 yes | no | yes | yes
5240
5241 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005242 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5243 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5244 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005245
5246 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5247
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005248 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5249 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5250 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5251 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5252 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5253 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5254 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5255 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5256 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5257 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005258
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005259 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5260 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5261 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5262 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5263 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5264 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5265 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5266 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005267
5268 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5269 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5270 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5271 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5272 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5273 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5274 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5275 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005276 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005277 downsides of rare connection failures.
5278
5279 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5280 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5281 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5282 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5283 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5284 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005285 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005286 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5287 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5288 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5289 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5290 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5291
5292 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005293 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5294 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5295 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005296
5297 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005298 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005299
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005300 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5301 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005302
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005303 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005304
5305 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5306 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5307 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5308
5309 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5310
5311
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005312http-send-name-header [<header>]
5313 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005314 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5315 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005316 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005317 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5318
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005319 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5320 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5321 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5322 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5323 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5324 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5325 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5326 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5327 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5328 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5329 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5330 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5331 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5332 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5333 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5334 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005335
5336 See also : "server"
5337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005338id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005339 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5341 no | yes | yes | yes
5342 Arguments : none
5343
5344 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5345 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5346 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005347
5348
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005349ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5350 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5351 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005352 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005353
5354 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5355 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5356 and running).
5357
5358 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5359 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5360 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005361 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005362 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5363
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005364 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5365 "unless" condition is met.
5366
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005367 Example:
5368 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5369 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5370 ignore-persist if url_static
5371
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005372 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5373
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005374load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5375 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5376 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5377 yes | no | yes | yes
5378
5379 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5380 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5381 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005382 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005383 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5384 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5385 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5386 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5387
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005388 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005389 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005390 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005391
5392 Arguments:
5393 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5394 named "server-state-file".
5395
5396 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5397 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5398 name is used as a file name.
5399
5400 none don't load any stat for this backend
5401
5402 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005403 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5404 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5405 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005406 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005407 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005408
5409 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5410 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5411
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005412 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005413
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005414 global
5415 stats socket /tmp/socket
5416 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005417
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005418 defaults
5419 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005420
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005421 backend bk
5422 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5423 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005424
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005425
5426 Then one can run :
5427
5428 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5429
5430 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5431
5432 1
5433 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5434 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5435 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5436
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005437 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005438
5439 global
5440 stats socket /tmp/socket
5441 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5442
5443 defaults
5444 load-server-state-from-file local
5445
5446 backend bk
5447 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5448 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5449
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005450
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005451 Then one can run :
5452
5453 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5454
5455 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5456
5457 1
5458 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5459 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5460 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5461
5462 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5463 "show servers state"
5464
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005465
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005466log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005467log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5468 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005469no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005470 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5472 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005473
5474 Prefix :
5475 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5476 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5477 prefix does not allow arguments.
5478
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005479 Arguments :
5480 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5481 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5482 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5483 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5484 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5485 parameter.
5486
5487 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5488 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5489
5490 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5491 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5492 standard syslog port).
5493
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005494 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5495 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5496 standard syslog port).
5497
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005498 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5499 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5500 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005501 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005502
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005503 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5504 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5505 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5506 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5507 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5508 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5509 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5510 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5511 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5512 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5513 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5514 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5515 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5516 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5517 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5518 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005519 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5520 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005521
5522 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5523 and "fd@2", see above.
5524
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005525 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5526 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5527 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5528 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5529 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5530 having the logs instantly available.
5531
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005532 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5533 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005534
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005535 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5536 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5537 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5538 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5539 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5540 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5541 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5542 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5543 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5544 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005545 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005546
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005547 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5548 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5549 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5550 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5551 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5552
5553 <sample_size>
5554 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5555 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5556 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5557 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5558 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5559
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005560 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5561 one of the following :
5562
5563 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5564 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5565
5566 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5567 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5568
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005569 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5570 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5571 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5572 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5573 systemd logger consumes.
5574
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005575 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5576 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5577 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5578 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005580 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5581
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005582 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5583 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5584 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5585
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005586 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5587 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5588 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5589 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005590
5591 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5592 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5593 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005594 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5595 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5596 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5597 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5598 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005599
5600 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5601
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005602 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5603 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5604 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005605
5606 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5607 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5608 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5609 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5610
5611 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5612 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005613
5614 Example :
5615 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005616 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5617 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5618 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005619 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5620 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005621 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005622
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005623
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005624log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005625 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5627 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005628
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005629 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5630 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5631 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5632 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5633 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005634
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005635 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5636 "option httplog" directives.
5637
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005638log-format-sd <string>
5639 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5641 yes | yes | yes | no
5642
5643 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5644 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5645 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5646 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5647 which covers the log format string in depth.
5648
5649 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5650 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5651
5652 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5653 log format to "rfc5424".
5654
5655 Example :
5656 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5657
5658
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005659log-tag <string>
5660 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5661 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5662 yes | yes | yes | yes
5663
5664 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5665 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5666 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5667 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5668 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5669 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5670 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5671 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5672 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005673
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005674max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5675 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 yes | no | yes | yes
5678
5679 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5680 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5681 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5682 servers.
5683
5684 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5685 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5686 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5687 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5688 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005689 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005690 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5691 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5692 picking a different server.
5693
5694 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5695 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5696 even if they have to be queued.
5697
5698 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5699 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5700
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005701max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5702 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5703 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5704 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005705
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005706maxconn <conns>
5707 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 yes | yes | yes | no
5710 Arguments :
5711 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5712 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5713 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5714 closes.
5715
5716 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5717 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5718 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5719 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005720 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5721 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5722 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5723 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005724
5725 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5726 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5727 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5728
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005729 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5730 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005732 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5733
5734
5735mode { tcp|http|health }
5736 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5738 yes | yes | yes | yes
5739 Arguments :
5740 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5741 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5742 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5743 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5744
5745 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5746 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5747 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5748 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5749 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5750
5751 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005752 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5753 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5754 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5755 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5756 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5757 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5758 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005759
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005760 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5761 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5762 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005763
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005764 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005765 defaults http_instances
5766 mode http
5767
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005768 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005770
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005771monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005772 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005775 Arguments :
5776 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5777 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005778 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005779 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5780 backend and its backup.
5781
5782 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5783 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5784 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5785 servers in a list of backends.
5786
5787 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5788 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5789 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5790 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5791 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5792 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5793 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005794 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5795 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005796
5797 Example:
5798 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005799 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005800 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5801 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5802 monitor-uri /site_alive
5803 monitor fail if site_dead
5804
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005805 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005806
5807
5808monitor-net <source>
5809 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5811 yes | yes | yes | no
5812 Arguments :
5813 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5814 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5815 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5816 followed by a mask.
5817
5818 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5819 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005820 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005821 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5822
5823 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5824 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5825 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5826 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005827 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5828 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5829 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005830
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005831 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5832 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5833 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5834 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5835 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5836 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005837
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005838 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5839 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005840
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005841 Example :
5842 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5843 frontend www
5844 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5845
5846 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5847
5848
5849monitor-uri <uri>
5850 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5852 yes | yes | yes | no
5853 Arguments :
5854 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5855 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5856
5857 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5858 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5859 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5860 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5861 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5862 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5863 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5864 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5865
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005866 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005867 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5868 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5869 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5870 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5871 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5872 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005873
5874 Example :
5875 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5876 frontend www
5877 mode http
5878 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5879
5880 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005882
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005883option abortonclose
5884no option abortonclose
5885 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5887 yes | no | yes | yes
5888 Arguments : none
5889
5890 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5891 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5892 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5893 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005894 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005895 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5896 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5897 encountered while delivering the response.
5898
5899 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5900 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5901 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5902 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5903 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5904 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005905 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005906 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005907 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005908 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5909 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5910 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5911
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005912 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5913 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005914 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5915 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5916 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5917 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5918 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5919 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005920 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005921
5922 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5923 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5924
5925 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5926
5927
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005928option accept-invalid-http-request
5929no option accept-invalid-http-request
5930 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 yes | yes | yes | no
5933 Arguments : none
5934
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005935 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005936 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005937 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005938 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5939 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5940 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5941 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5942 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005943 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5944 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5945 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5946 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005947 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005948 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005949 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5950 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5951 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005952
5953 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5954 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5955 been confirmed.
5956
5957 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5958 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005959 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5960 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005961 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5962
5963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5965
5966 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5967 stats socket.
5968
5969
5970option accept-invalid-http-response
5971no option accept-invalid-http-response
5972 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5974 yes | no | yes | yes
5975 Arguments : none
5976
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005977 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005978 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005979 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005980 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5981 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5982 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5983 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5984 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005985 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5986 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5987 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005988
5989 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5990 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5991 been confirmed.
5992
5993 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5994 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5995 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5996 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5997
5998 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5999 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6000
6001 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6002 stats socket.
6003
6004
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006005option allbackups
6006no option allbackups
6007 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6009 yes | no | yes | yes
6010 Arguments : none
6011
6012 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6013 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6014 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6015 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6016 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6017 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6018 order between the backup servers anymore.
6019
6020 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6021 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6022
6023 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6024 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6025
6026
6027option checkcache
6028no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006029 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6031 yes | no | yes | yes
6032 Arguments : none
6033
6034 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6035 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006036 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006037 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6038 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006039 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006040
6041 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006042 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006043 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006044 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6045 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006046 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006047 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006048 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6049 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006050 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006051 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6052 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006053 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006054 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6055 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6056 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6057 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6058 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6059 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6060 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6061 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6062 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6063
6064 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006065 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6066 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6067 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6068 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006069
6070 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6071 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006072 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006073 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006074
6075 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6076 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6077
6078
6079option clitcpka
6080no option clitcpka
6081 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6083 yes | yes | yes | no
6084 Arguments : none
6085
6086 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6087 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006088 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006089 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6090
6091 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6092 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6093 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6094 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6095
6096 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6097 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6098 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6099 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6100 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6101
6102 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6103
6104 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6105 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6106 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6107
6108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6110
6111 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6112
6113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006114option contstats
6115 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6117 yes | yes | yes | no
6118 Arguments : none
6119
6120 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6121 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6122 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6123 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006124 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6125 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6126 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6127 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6128 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006129
6130
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006131option dontlog-normal
6132no option dontlog-normal
6133 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6135 yes | yes | yes | no
6136 Arguments : none
6137
6138 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6139 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6140 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6141 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6142 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6143 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6144 logged.
6145
6146 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6147 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6148 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006150 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006151 logging.
6152
6153
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006154option dontlognull
6155no option dontlognull
6156 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6158 yes | yes | yes | no
6159 Arguments : none
6160
6161 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6162 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6163 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6164 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6165 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6166 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006167 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6168 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6169 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006170
6171 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006172 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006173 would not be logged.
6174
6175 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6176 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6177
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006178 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6179 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006180
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006181
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006182option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006183 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6185 yes | yes | yes | yes
6186 Arguments :
6187 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6188 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006189 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006190 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006191
6192 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6193 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6194 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6195 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6196 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6197 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6198 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006199 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6200 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6201 possible that the client has already brought one.
6202
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006203 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006204 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006205 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006206 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006207 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006208 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006209
6210 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6211 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6212 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6213 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6214 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6215 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6216 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6217
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006218 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6219 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6220 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6221 are under the control of the end-user.
6222
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006223 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006224 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6225 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006226 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6227 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6228 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006229
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006230 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006231 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6232 frontend www
6233 mode http
6234 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6235
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006236 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6237 backend www
6238 mode http
6239 option forwardfor header X-Client
6240
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006241 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006242 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006243
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006244
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006245option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6246no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6247 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6249 yes | yes | yes | no
6250 Arguments : none
6251
6252 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6253 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6254 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6255 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6256 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6257 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6258 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6259
6260 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6261 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6262 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6263 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6264 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6265 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6266 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6267 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6268 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6269 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6270
6271 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6272
6273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6275
6276 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6277 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6278
6279
6280option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6281no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6282 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6284 yes | no | yes | yes
6285 Arguments : none
6286
6287 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6288 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6289 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6290 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6291 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6292 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6293 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6294
6295 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6296 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6297 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6298 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6299 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6300 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6301 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6302 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6303 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6304 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6305
6306 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6307
6308 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6309 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6310
6311 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6312 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6313
6314
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006315option http-buffer-request
6316no option http-buffer-request
6317 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6319 yes | yes | yes | yes
6320 Arguments : none
6321
6322 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6323 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6324 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6325 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6326 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6327 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006328 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6329 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6330 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6331 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006332
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006333 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006334
6335
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006336option http-ignore-probes
6337no option http-ignore-probes
6338 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6340 yes | yes | yes | no
6341 Arguments : none
6342
6343 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6344 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6345 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6346 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6347 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6348 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6349 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6350 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6351 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006352 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6353 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006354 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6355
6356 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6357 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6358 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6359 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6360 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6361 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6362 are often the only way to detect them.
6363
6364 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6365 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6366
6367 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6368
6369
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006370option http-keep-alive
6371no option http-keep-alive
6372 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6374 yes | yes | yes | yes
6375 Arguments : none
6376
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006377 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6378 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006379 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6380 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006381 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6382 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6383 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006384
6385 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6386 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006387 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6388 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6389 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6390 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6391 situations where this option may be useful :
6392
6393 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006394 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006395
6396 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6397 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6398
6399 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6400 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6401 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6402 request.
6403
6404 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6405 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006406 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6407 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6408 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006409
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006410 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6411 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6412 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6413 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6414 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6415 not set.
6416
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006417 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6418 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6419 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006420
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006421 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006422 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006423 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006424
6425
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006426option http-no-delay
6427no option http-no-delay
6428 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 yes | yes | yes | yes
6431 Arguments : none
6432
6433 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6434 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6435 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6436 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6437 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6438 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6439 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6440 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6441 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6442 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6443 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6444 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6445 affected.
6446
6447 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6448 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6449 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6450 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6451 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6452 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6453 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6454 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6455 latency environments.
6456
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006457 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6458
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006459
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006460option http-pretend-keepalive
6461no option http-pretend-keepalive
6462 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006464 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006465 Arguments : none
6466
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006467 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006468 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6469 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6470 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6471 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6472 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6473 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6474 consider the response complete.
6475
6476 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6477 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6478 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6479 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006480 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006481 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6482
6483 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6484 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6485 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6486 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6487 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6488 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6489 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6490
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006491 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6492 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6493 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6494 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6495 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6496 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006497
6498 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6499 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6500
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006501 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006502 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006503
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006504
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006505option http-server-close
6506no option http-server-close
6507 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6509 yes | yes | yes | yes
6510 Arguments : none
6511
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006512 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6513 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6514 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6515 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006516 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6517 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6518 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6519 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6520 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6521 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6522 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6523 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6524 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6525 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6526 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006527
6528 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6529 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6530 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6531 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006532 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6533 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006534
6535 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6536 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006537 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6538 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6539 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006540
6541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6543
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006544 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6545 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006546
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006547option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006548no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006549 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | yes | yes | no
6552 Arguments : none
6553
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006554 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006555 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6556 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6557 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6558 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6559 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6560 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6561
6562 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6563 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006564 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6565 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6566 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006567
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006568 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6569 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6570 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6571 front of an existing proxy.
6572
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006573 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6574
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006575 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006576
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006577option httpchk
6578option httpchk <uri>
6579option httpchk <method> <uri>
6580option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6581 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6583 yes | no | yes | yes
6584 Arguments :
6585 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6586 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6587 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6588 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6589 ones.
6590
6591 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6592 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6593 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6594
6595 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6596 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6597 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6598 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6599 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6600
6601 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6602 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6603 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6604 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6605 the lack of any response.
6606
6607 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6608
6609 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6610 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6611 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6612
6613 Examples :
6614 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6615 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6616 backend https_relay
6617 mode tcp
6618 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6619 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6620
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006621 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6622 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6623 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006624
6625
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006626option httpclose
6627no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006628 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6630 yes | yes | yes | yes
6631 Arguments : none
6632
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006633 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6634 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6635 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6636 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006637 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006638
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006639 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6640 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006641 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006642 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6643 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006644
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006645 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6646 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6647 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006648
6649 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6650 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006651 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6652 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6653 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006654
6655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6657
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006658 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006659
6660
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006661option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006662 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006664 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006665 Arguments :
6666 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6667 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6668 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006669 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006670 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006671
6672 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6673 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6674 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6675 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6676 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6677 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6678 ports.
6679
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006680 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6681 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006682
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006683 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006685 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006686
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006687
6688option http_proxy
6689no option http_proxy
6690 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6692 yes | yes | yes | yes
6693 Arguments : none
6694
6695 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6696 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6697 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6698 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6699 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6700
6701 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6702 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006703 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6704 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006705
6706 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6707 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6708
6709 Example :
6710 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6711 backend direct_forward
6712 option httpclose
6713 option http_proxy
6714
6715 See also : "option httpclose"
6716
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006717
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006718option independent-streams
6719no option independent-streams
6720 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6722 yes | yes | yes | yes
6723 Arguments : none
6724
6725 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6726 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6727 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6728 receive data or not.
6729
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006730 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006731 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6732 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6733 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6734 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6735 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6736 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6737 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6738 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6739 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6740 socket buffers.
6741
6742 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6743 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6744 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6745 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6746 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6747
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006748 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006749
6750
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006751option ldap-check
6752 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6754 yes | no | yes | yes
6755 Arguments : none
6756
6757 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6758 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6759 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6760 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6761
6762 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6763 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6764
6765 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6766 configure it.
6767
6768 Example :
6769 option ldap-check
6770
6771 See also : "option httpchk"
6772
6773
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006774option external-check
6775 Use external processes for server health checks
6776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6777 yes | no | yes | yes
6778
6779 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6780 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6781 command".
6782
6783 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6784
6785 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6786
6787
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006788option log-health-checks
6789no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006790 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6792 yes | no | yes | yes
6793 Arguments : none
6794
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006795 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6796 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6797 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006798
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006799 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6800 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6801 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6802 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6803 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6804
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006805 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006806 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006807
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006808 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6809 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6810 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006811
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006812
6813option log-separate-errors
6814no option log-separate-errors
6815 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6817 yes | yes | yes | no
6818 Arguments : none
6819
6820 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6821 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6822 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6823 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6824 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6825 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6826 provides very important information.
6827
6828 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6829 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6830 error logs.
6831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006832 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006833 logging.
6834
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006835
6836option logasap
6837no option logasap
6838 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 yes | yes | yes | no
6841 Arguments : none
6842
6843 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6844 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6845 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6846 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6847 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6848 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6849 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006850 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006851 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6852 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6853
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006854 Examples :
6855 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6856 mode http
6857 option httplog
6858 option logasap
6859 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6860
6861 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6862 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6863 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6864 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006866 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006867 logging.
6868
6869
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006870option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006871 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6873 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006874 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006875 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6876 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006877 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006878
6879 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6880 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006881 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006882 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6883 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6884 in the MySQL table, like this :
6885
6886 USE mysql;
6887 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6888 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6889
6890 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006891 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006892 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6893 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6894 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6895 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6896 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6897 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6898 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6899
6900 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6901 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006902
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006903 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006904
6905 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6906 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6907 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6908 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006909 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6910 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006911
6912 See also: "option httpchk"
6913
6914
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006915option nolinger
6916no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006917 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006918 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6919 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006920 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006921
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006922 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006923 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6924 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6925 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6926 connections.
6927
6928 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6929 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6930 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6931 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6932 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6933 this too.
6934
6935 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6936 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6937 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6938
6939 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6940 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6941 for servers.
6942
6943 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6944 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6945
6946
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006947option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6948 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | yes | yes | yes
6951 Arguments :
6952 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6953 matching <network>
6954 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6955 header name.
6956
6957 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6958 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6959 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6960 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6961 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6962 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6963 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6964 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6965 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6966 possible that the client has already brought one.
6967
6968 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6969 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6970 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6971 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6972 header and requires different one.
6973
6974 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6975 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6976 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6977 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6978 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6979 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6980 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6981
6982 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6983 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6984 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6985 both are defined.
6986
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006987 Examples :
6988 # Original Destination address
6989 frontend www
6990 mode http
6991 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6992
6993 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6994 backend www
6995 mode http
6996 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6997
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006998 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006999
7000
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007001option persist
7002no option persist
7003 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7004 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7005 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007006 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007007
7008 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7009 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7010 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7011 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7012 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7013 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7014 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7015 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7016 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7017 redirected to another valid server.
7018
7019 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7020 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7021
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007022 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007023
7024
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007025option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7026 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7028 yes | no | yes | yes
7029 Arguments :
7030 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7031 PostgreSQL server.
7032
7033 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7034 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7035 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7036 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7037
7038 See also: "option httpchk"
7039
7040
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007041option prefer-last-server
7042no option prefer-last-server
7043 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7044 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7045 yes | no | yes | yes
7046 Arguments : none
7047
7048 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7049 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7050 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7051 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7052 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7053 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7054 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7055 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7056 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007057 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7058 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007059 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7060 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7061 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007062 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7063 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7064 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007065
7066 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7067 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7068
7069 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7070
7071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007072option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007073option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007074no option redispatch
7075 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7076 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7077 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007078 Arguments :
7079 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7080 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7081 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007082 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007083 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007084 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007085 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7086 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7087 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007089
7090 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7091 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7092 be able to access the service anymore.
7093
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007094 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7095 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007096
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007097 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007098 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7099 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007101 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7102 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7103
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007104 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007105
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007106
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007107option redis-check
7108 Use redis health checks for server testing
7109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7110 yes | no | yes | yes
7111 Arguments : none
7112
7113 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7114 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7115 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7116 find the "+PONG" response message.
7117
7118 Example :
7119 option redis-check
7120
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007121 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007122
7123
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007124option smtpchk
7125option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7126 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7128 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007129 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007130 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007131 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007132 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7133
7134 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7135 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7136 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7137
7138 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7139 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7140 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7141 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7142 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7143 dead server.
7144
7145 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7146 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007147 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007148 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7149
7150 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7151 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7152 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7153 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007154 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007155
7156 Example :
7157 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7158
7159 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007162option socket-stats
7163no option socket-stats
7164
7165 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7167 yes | yes | yes | no
7168
7169 Arguments : none
7170
7171
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007172option splice-auto
7173no option splice-auto
7174 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7176 yes | yes | yes | yes
7177 Arguments : none
7178
7179 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7180 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007181 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007182 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007183 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007184 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7185 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7186 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7187 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7188
7189 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7190 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7191 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7192 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7193 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7194 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7195 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7196 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7197 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7198 keyword.
7199
7200 Example :
7201 option splice-auto
7202
7203 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7204 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7205
7206 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7207 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7208
7209
7210option splice-request
7211no option splice-request
7212 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7214 yes | yes | yes | yes
7215 Arguments : none
7216
7217 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007218 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007219 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7220 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7221 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7222 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7223
7224 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7225
7226 Example :
7227 option splice-request
7228
7229 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7230 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7231
7232 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7233 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7234
7235
7236option splice-response
7237no option splice-response
7238 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7240 yes | yes | yes | yes
7241 Arguments : none
7242
7243 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007244 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007245 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7246 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7247 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7248 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7249
7250 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7251
7252 Example :
7253 option splice-response
7254
7255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7257
7258 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7259 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7260
7261
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007262option spop-check
7263 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7265 no | no | no | yes
7266 Arguments : none
7267
7268 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7269 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7270 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7271 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7272
7273 Example :
7274 option spop-check
7275
7276 See also : "option httpchk"
7277
7278
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007279option srvtcpka
7280no option srvtcpka
7281 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7283 yes | no | yes | yes
7284 Arguments : none
7285
7286 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7287 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007288 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007289 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7290
7291 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7292 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7293 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7294 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7295
7296 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7297 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7298 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7299 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7300 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7301
7302 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7303
7304 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7305 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7306 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7307
7308 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7309 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7310
7311 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7312
7313
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007314option ssl-hello-chk
7315 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7317 yes | no | yes | yes
7318 Arguments : none
7319
7320 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7321 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7322 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7323 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7324 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7325 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7326 hello message.
7327
7328 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7329 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7330 messages, which is appreciable.
7331
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007332 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7333 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7334 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007335
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007336 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7337
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007338
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007339option tcp-check
7340 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7342 yes | no | yes | yes
7343
7344 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7345 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7346
7347 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7348 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7349 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7350
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007351 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007352 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7353 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7354 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7355 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7356 only.
7357
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007358 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007359 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7360 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7361 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7362 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7363
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007364 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007365 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7366 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007367 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007368 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7369 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7370 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7371 the respective protocols.
7372 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007373 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007374
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007375 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7376 script.
7377
7378 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7379 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7380 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7381 The "comment" is of course optional.
7382
7383
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007384 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007385 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007386 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007387 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007388
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007389 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007390 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007391 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007392
7393 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7394 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007395 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007396 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007397 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007398 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007399 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007400 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007401 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7402 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007403 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007404 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7405 tcp-check expect string +OK
7406
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007407 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007408 (send many headers before analyzing)
7409 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007410 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007411 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7412 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7413 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7414 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007415 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007416
7417
7418 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7419
7420
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007421option tcp-smart-accept
7422no option tcp-smart-accept
7423 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7425 yes | yes | yes | no
7426 Arguments : none
7427
7428 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7429 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7430 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7431 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7432 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7433 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7434
7435 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7436 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7437 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7438 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7439
7440 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7441 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7442 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007443 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007444
7445 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7446 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7447 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7448
7449 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7450 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7451 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7452
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007453 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7454
7455
7456option tcp-smart-connect
7457no option tcp-smart-connect
7458 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7460 yes | no | yes | yes
7461 Arguments : none
7462
7463 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7464 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7465 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7466 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7467 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7468
7469 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7470 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7471 complex.
7472
7473 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7474 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7475 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7476
7477 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7478 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7479
7480 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7481
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007482
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007483option tcpka
7484 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7486 yes | yes | yes | yes
7487 Arguments : none
7488
7489 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7490 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007491 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007492 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7493
7494 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7495 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7496 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7497 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7498
7499 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7500 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7501 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7502 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7503 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7504
7505 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7506
7507 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7508 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7509 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7510 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7511 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7512 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7513 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7514 backends.
7515
7516 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7517
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007518
7519option tcplog
7520 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007522 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007523 Arguments : none
7524
7525 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7526 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7527 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7528 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7529 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7530 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7531 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7532 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7533
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007534 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007536 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007537
7538
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007539option transparent
7540no option transparent
7541 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007543 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007544 Arguments : none
7545
7546 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7547 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7548 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7549 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7550 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7551 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7552 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7553 appropriate server.
7554
7555 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7556 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7557
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007558 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007559 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007560
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007561
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007562external-check command <command>
7563 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7565 yes | no | yes | yes
7566
7567 Arguments :
7568 <command> is the external command to run
7569
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007570 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7571
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007572 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007573
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007574 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7575 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7576 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7577 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7578 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7579 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007580
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007581 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7582
7583 Environment variables :
7584 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7585 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7586
7587 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7588
7589 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7590
7591 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7592 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7593 for a UNIX socket).
7594
7595 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7596
7597 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7598
7599 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7600
7601 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7602
7603 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7604
7605 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7606 socket).
7607
7608 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7609 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7610
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007611 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7612
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007613 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7614 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7615 failed.
7616
7617 Example :
7618 external-check command /bin/true
7619
7620 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7621
7622
7623external-check path <path>
7624 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7626 yes | no | yes | yes
7627
7628 Arguments :
7629 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7630
7631 The default path is "".
7632
7633 Example :
7634 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7635
7636 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7637 "external-check command"
7638
7639
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007640persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007641persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007642 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7644 yes | no | yes | yes
7645 Arguments :
7646 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007647 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7648 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007649
7650 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7651 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007652 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007653 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7654 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7655 forwarded to this server.
7656
7657 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7658 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7659 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007660 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007661 a single "listen" section.
7662
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007663 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7664 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7665 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7666
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007667 Example :
7668 listen tse-farm
7669 bind :3389
7670 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7671 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7672 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7673 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7674 persist rdp-cookie
7675 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007676 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007677 balance rdp-cookie
7678 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7679 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7680
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007681 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7682 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007683
7684
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007685rate-limit sessions <rate>
7686 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7688 yes | yes | yes | no
7689 Arguments :
7690 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7691 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7692
7693 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7694 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7695 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7696 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7697 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7698 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7699
7700 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7701 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7702 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7703 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7704
7705 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7706 listen smtp
7707 mode tcp
7708 bind :25
7709 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007710 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007711
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007712 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7713 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7714 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007715
7716 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7717
7718
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007719redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7720redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7721redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007722 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7724 no | yes | yes | yes
7725
7726 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007727 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007728
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007729 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007730 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007731 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7732 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7733 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007734
7735 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7736 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7737 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7738 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7739 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007740 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7741 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7742 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7743 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007744
7745 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7746 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7747 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7748 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7749 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7750 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007751 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007752 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007753 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7754 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7755 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007756
7757 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007758 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7759 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7760 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007761 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007762 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7763 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7764 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7765 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007766
7767 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007768 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007769
7770 - "drop-query"
7771 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7772 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7773 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7774 with a location-type redirect.
7775
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007776 - "append-slash"
7777 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7778 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7779 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7780 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7781
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007782 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7783 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7784 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7785 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7786 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7787 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7788 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7789
7790 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7791 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7792 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7793 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7794 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7795 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7796 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007797
7798 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7799 acl clear dst_port 80
7800 acl secure dst_port 8080
7801 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007802 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007803 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007804 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7805
7806 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007807 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7808 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7809 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007810 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007811
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007812 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7813 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7814 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7815
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007816 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007817 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007818
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007819 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007820 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7821 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7822 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007824 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007825
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007826
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007827retries <value>
7828 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7829 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 yes | no | yes | yes
7831 Arguments :
7832 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7833 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7834 default value is 3.
7835
7836 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7837 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7838 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7839
7840 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007841 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7842 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007843
7844 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7845 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7846
7847 See also : "option redispatch"
7848
7849
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007850retry-on [list of keywords]
7851 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7853 yes | no | yes | yes
7854 Arguments :
7855 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7856 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7857 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7858 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7859
7860 none never retry
7861
7862 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7863 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7864
7865 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7866 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7867 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7868 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7869 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7870 processing the request.
7871
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007872 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7873 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7874 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7875 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7876 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7877 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7878 overflow attack for example).
7879
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007880 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7881 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7882 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7883 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7884 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7885 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7886 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7887 amplify denial of service attacks.
7888
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007889 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7890 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7891 considered to be safe to retry.
7892
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007893 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7894 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7895 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7896 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7897
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007898 all-retryable-errors
7899 retry request for any error that are considered
7900 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7901 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7902 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7903
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007904 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7905 not cumulative.
7906
7907 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7908 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7909 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7910 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7911
7912 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7913 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7914 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7915 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7916 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7917 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7918 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7919 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7920 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7921 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7922 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7923 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7924
7925 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7926 should not use this directive.
7927
7928 The default is "conn-failure".
7929
7930 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7931
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007932server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007933 Declare a server in a backend
7934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 no | no | yes | yes
7936 Arguments :
7937 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007938 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007939 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007940
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007941 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7942 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7943 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7944 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007945 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7946 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7947 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7948 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7949 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007950 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7951 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7952 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7953 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7954 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7955 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7956 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007957 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007958 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7959 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7960 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7961 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7962 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7963 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007964 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7965 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007966 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7967 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007968
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007969 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007970 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7971 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7972 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7973 adding this value to the client's port.
7974
7975 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7976 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007977 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007978
7979 Examples :
7980 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7981 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007982 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007983 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7984 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7985 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007986
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007987 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7988 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7989 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7990 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7991 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7992
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007993 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7994 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007995
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007996server-state-file-name [<file>]
7997 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7998 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7999 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8000 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8001 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8002 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8003
8004 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8005 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8006
8007 global
8008 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8009
8010 backend bk
8011 load-server-state-from-file
8012
8013 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8014 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008015
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008016server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8017 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8018 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8020 no | no | yes | yes
8021
8022 Arguments:
8023 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8024
8025 <num | range>
8026 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8027 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8028 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8029 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8030
8031 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8032
8033 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8034
8035 <params*>
8036 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8037 keyword.
8038
8039 Examples:
8040 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8041 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8042 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8043
8044 # or
8045 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8046
8047 # would be equivalent to:
8048 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8049 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8050 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8051
8052
8053
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008054source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008055source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008056source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008057 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8059 yes | no | yes | yes
8060 Arguments :
8061 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8062 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008063
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008064 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008065 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8066 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8067 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8068 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8069 supported prefixes are :
8070 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8071 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8072 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008073 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008074 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8075 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008076
8077 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8078 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008079 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8080 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8081 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008082
8083 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8084 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8085 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8086 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8087 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8088 <addr>.
8089
8090 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8091 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8092 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8093 port.
8094
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008095 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8096 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8097 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8098 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008099 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008100 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8101 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8102 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8103 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8104 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8105 HTTP header.
8106
8107 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8108 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008109 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008110 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8111 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8112 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8113 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8114 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8115 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8116 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8117
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008118 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8119 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8120 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8121 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8122 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8123 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8124
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008125 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8126 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8127 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8128 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8129
8130 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8131 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8132 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8133 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8134 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8135 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8136
8137 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8138 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8139 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8140 there are two methods :
8141
8142 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8143 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8144 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8145 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8146 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8147 of the client ranges may be used.
8148
8149 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8150 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8151 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8152 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8153 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8154 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8155 same session.
8156
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008157 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8158 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8159 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008160 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008161
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008162 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8163
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008164 Examples :
8165 backend private
8166 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8167 source 192.168.1.200
8168
8169 backend transparent_ssl1
8170 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8171 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8172
8173 backend transparent_ssl2
8174 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8175 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8176 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8177
8178 backend transparent_ssl3
8179 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8180 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8181 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8182
8183 backend transparent_smtp
8184 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8185 # with Tproxy version 4.
8186 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8187
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008188 backend transparent_http
8189 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8190 # proxy.
8191 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008193 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008194 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8195
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008196
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008197stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8198 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008200 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008201
8202 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8203 matched.
8204
8205 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8206 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8207
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008208 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8209 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008210 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008211
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008212 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8213 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8214 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8215 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008216
8217 Example :
8218 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8219 backend stats_localhost
8220 stats enable
8221 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8222
8223 Example :
8224 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8225 backend stats_auth
8226 stats enable
8227 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8228 stats admin if TRUE
8229
8230 Example :
8231 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8232 userlist stats-auth
8233 group admin users admin
8234 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8235 group readonly users haproxy
8236 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8237
8238 backend stats_auth
8239 stats enable
8240 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8241 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8242 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8243 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8244
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008245 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8246 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8247 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008248
8249
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008250stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8251 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008253 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008254 Arguments :
8255 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8256
8257 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8258
8259 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8260 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8261 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8262 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8263 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8264 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8265
8266 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8267 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8268 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008269 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008270
8271 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8272 report using "stats scope".
8273
8274 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8275 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8276 unobvious parameters.
8277
8278 Example :
8279 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8280 backend public_www
8281 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8282 stats enable
8283 stats hide-version
8284 stats scope .
8285 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008286 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008287 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8288 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8289
8290 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8291 backend private_monitoring
8292 stats enable
8293 stats uri /admin?stats
8294 stats refresh 5s
8295
8296 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8297
8298
8299stats enable
8300 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008302 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008303 Arguments : none
8304
8305 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8306 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8307 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8308 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8309 - stats auth : no authentication
8310 - stats scope : no restriction
8311
8312 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8313 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8314 unobvious parameters.
8315
8316 Example :
8317 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8318 backend public_www
8319 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8320 stats enable
8321 stats hide-version
8322 stats scope .
8323 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008324 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008325 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8326 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8327
8328 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8329 backend private_monitoring
8330 stats enable
8331 stats uri /admin?stats
8332 stats refresh 5s
8333
8334 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8335
8336
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008337stats hide-version
8338 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008340 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008341 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008342
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008343 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8344 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8345 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8346 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8347 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8348 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008350 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8351 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8352 unobvious parameters.
8353
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008354 Example :
8355 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8356 backend public_www
8357 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008358 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008359 stats hide-version
8360 stats scope .
8361 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008362 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008363 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8364 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008365
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008366 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8367 backend private_monitoring
8368 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008369 stats uri /admin?stats
8370 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008371
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008372 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008373
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008374
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008375stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8376 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8377 Access control for statistics
8378
8379 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8380 no | no | yes | yes
8381
8382 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8383 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8384 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8385 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8386 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8387 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8388
8389 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8390 instance.
8391
8392 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8393 about ACL usage.
8394
8395
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008396stats realm <realm>
8397 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008399 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008400 Arguments :
8401 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8402 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8403 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8404
8405 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8406 using a backslash ('\').
8407
8408 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8409 only related to authentication.
8410
8411 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8412 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8413 unobvious parameters.
8414
8415 Example :
8416 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8417 backend public_www
8418 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8419 stats enable
8420 stats hide-version
8421 stats scope .
8422 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008423 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008424 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8425 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8426
8427 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8428 backend private_monitoring
8429 stats enable
8430 stats uri /admin?stats
8431 stats refresh 5s
8432
8433 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8434
8435
8436stats refresh <delay>
8437 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008439 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008440 Arguments :
8441 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8442 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8443 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8444 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8445 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8446 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8447
8448 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8449 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8450 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8451 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8452
8453 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8454 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8455 unobvious parameters.
8456
8457 Example :
8458 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8459 backend public_www
8460 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8461 stats enable
8462 stats hide-version
8463 stats scope .
8464 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008465 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008466 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8467 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8468
8469 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8470 backend private_monitoring
8471 stats enable
8472 stats uri /admin?stats
8473 stats refresh 5s
8474
8475 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8476
8477
8478stats scope { <name> | "." }
8479 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008481 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008482 Arguments :
8483 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8484 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8485 section in which the statement appears.
8486
8487 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8488 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8489 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8490 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8491 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8492 exists.
8493
8494 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8495 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8496 unobvious parameters.
8497
8498 Example :
8499 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8500 backend public_www
8501 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8502 stats enable
8503 stats hide-version
8504 stats scope .
8505 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008506 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008507 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8508 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8509
8510 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8511 backend private_monitoring
8512 stats enable
8513 stats uri /admin?stats
8514 stats refresh 5s
8515
8516 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8517
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008518
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008519stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008520 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008522 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008523
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008524 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008525 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8526
8527 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8528 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8529
8530 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8531 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008532 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008533
8534 Example :
8535 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8536 backend private_monitoring
8537 stats enable
8538 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8539 stats uri /admin?stats
8540 stats refresh 5s
8541
8542 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8543 global section.
8544
8545
8546stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008547 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8549 yes | yes | yes | yes
8550 Arguments : none
8551
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008552 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008553 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8554 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8555 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8556 - IP (socket, server)
8557 - cookie (backend, server)
8558
8559 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8560 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008561 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008562
8563 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8564
8565
8566stats show-node [ <name> ]
8567 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008569 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008570 Arguments:
8571 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8572 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8573
8574 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8575 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008576 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008577
8578 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8579 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8580 unobvious parameters.
8581
8582 Example:
8583 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8584 backend private_monitoring
8585 stats enable
8586 stats show-node Europe-1
8587 stats uri /admin?stats
8588 stats refresh 5s
8589
8590 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8591 section.
8592
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008593
8594stats uri <prefix>
8595 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008597 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008598 Arguments :
8599 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8600 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8601 query string.
8602
8603 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8604 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8605 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8606 possible to reach it in the application.
8607
8608 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008609 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008610 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8611 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8612 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8613 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8614
8615 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8616 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8617 an address or a port to statistics only.
8618
8619 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8620 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8621 unobvious parameters.
8622
8623 Example :
8624 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8625 backend public_www
8626 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8627 stats enable
8628 stats hide-version
8629 stats scope .
8630 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008631 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008632 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8633 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8634
8635 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8636 backend private_monitoring
8637 stats enable
8638 stats uri /admin?stats
8639 stats refresh 5s
8640
8641 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8642
8643
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008644stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8645 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008647 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008648
8649 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008650 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008651 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008652 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008653 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8654
8655 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8656 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8657 the "stick-table" statement.
8658
8659 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8660 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8661 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8662 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8663 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8664
8665 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8666 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8667 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8668 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8669 transformation rules.
8670
8671 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8672 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8673 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8674 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8675 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8676 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8677 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8678
8679 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8680 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8681 ACL based conditions.
8682
8683 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8684 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8685 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8686 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8687
8688 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8689 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8690 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8691 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8692
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008693 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8694 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008695 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008696
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008697 Example :
8698 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8699 # last 30 minutes
8700 backend pop
8701 mode tcp
8702 balance roundrobin
8703 stick store-request src
8704 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8705 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8706 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8707
8708 backend smtp
8709 mode tcp
8710 balance roundrobin
8711 stick match src table pop
8712 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8713 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8714
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008715 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008716 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008717
8718
8719stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8720 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8722 no | no | yes | yes
8723
8724 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8725 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8726 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8727 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8728
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008729 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8730 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008731 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008732
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008733 Examples :
8734 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008735 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008736
8737 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8738 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8739 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8740
8741
8742 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8743 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8744 backend http
8745 mode http
8746 balance roundrobin
8747 stick on src table https
8748 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8749 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8750 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8751
8752 backend https
8753 mode tcp
8754 balance roundrobin
8755 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8756 stick on src
8757 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8758 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8759
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008760 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008761
8762
8763stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8764 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8766 no | no | yes | yes
8767
8768 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008769 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008770 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008771 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008772 server is selected.
8773
8774 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8775 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8776 the "stick-table" statement.
8777
8778 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8779 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8780 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8781 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8782 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8783 address.
8784
8785 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8786 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8787 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8788 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8789 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8790 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8791 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8792 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8793 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8794 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8795
8796 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8797 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8798 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8799 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8800 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8801 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8802 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8803
8804 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8805 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8806 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8807 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8808
8809 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8810 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8811 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8812 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8813 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8814 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008815 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8816 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8817 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8818 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8819 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8820 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008821
8822 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8823 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8824 the request.
8825
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008826 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8827 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008828 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008829
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008830 Example :
8831 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8832 # last 30 minutes
8833 backend pop
8834 mode tcp
8835 balance roundrobin
8836 stick store-request src
8837 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8838 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8839 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8840
8841 backend smtp
8842 mode tcp
8843 balance roundrobin
8844 stick match src table pop
8845 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8846 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8847
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008848 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008849 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008850
8851
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008852stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008853 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8854 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008855 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008857 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008858
8859 Arguments :
8860 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8861 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8862 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8863 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8864
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008865 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8866 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8867 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8868 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8869
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008870 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8871 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8872 instance.
8873
8874 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8875 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8876 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8877 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8878 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8879 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008880 to 32 characters.
8881
8882 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8883 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8884 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008885 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008886 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8887 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008888
8889 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008890 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8891 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008892 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8893 increase.
8894
8895 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008896 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8897 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8898 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008899
8900 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8901 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8902 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8903 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008904 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008905 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8906 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8907 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8908 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8909 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8910 parameter (see below).
8911
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008912 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8913 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8914 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8915 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8916 soft restart.
8917
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008918 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8919 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008920
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008921 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8922 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8923 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8924 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008925 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008926 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008927 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8928 if not expiration delay is specified.
8929
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008930 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8931 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8932 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8933 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008934 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8935 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8936 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8937 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8938 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8939 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8940 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8941 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8942 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8943 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8944 types and their arguments.
8945
8946 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8947 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8948 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8949 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8950
8951 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8952 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8953 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008954 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008955
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008956 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8957 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8958 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008959 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008960 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008961 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008962
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008963 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8964 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8965 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8966 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8967
8968 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8969 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8970 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8971 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8972 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8973 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8974
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008975 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8976 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8977 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8978 they were received.
8979
8980 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8981 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8982 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8983 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8984 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8985
8986 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8987 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8988 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8989 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8990 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8991
8992 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8993 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8994 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8995
8996 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8997 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8998 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8999 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9000 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9001
9002 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9003 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9004 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9005 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9006 the client side.
9007
9008 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9009 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9010 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9011 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9012 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9013 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9014 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9015
9016 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9017 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9018 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9019 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9020 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9021 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009022 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009023
9024 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9025 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9026 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9027 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9028 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9029 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9030
9031 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009032 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009033 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9034 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9035
9036 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9037 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9038 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9039 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9040 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9041 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9042 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9043 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9044 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9045 recommended for better fairness.
9046
9047 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009048 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009049 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9050 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9051
9052 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9053 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9054 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9055 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9056 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9057 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9058 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9059 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9060 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9061 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009062
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009063 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9064 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009065 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9066 reference it.
9067
9068 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9069 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009070 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9071 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9072 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009073
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009074 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9075 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9076 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9077 something that can be ignored.
9078
9079 Example:
9080 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9081 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9082 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9083 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9084
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009085 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009086 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009087
9088
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009089stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009090 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9092 no | no | yes | yes
9093
9094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009095 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009096 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009097 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009098 server is selected.
9099
9100 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9101 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9102 the "stick-table" statement.
9103
9104 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9105 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9106 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9107 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9108
9109 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9110 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9111 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9112 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9113 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9114 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009115 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009116 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9117 rules.
9118
9119 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9120 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9121 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9122 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9123 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9124 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9125 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9126
9127 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9128 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9129 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9130 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9131
9132 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9133 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9134 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9135 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9136 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9137 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009138 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9139 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9140 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9141 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9142 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9143 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9144 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9145 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9146 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009147
9148 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9149
9150 Example :
9151 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9152 backend https
9153 mode tcp
9154 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009155 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009156 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009157
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009158 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9159 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9160
9161 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9162 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9163 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9164
9165 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9166 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009167
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009168 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9169 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9170 # at offset 44.
9171
9172 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9173 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9174
9175 # Learn on response if server hello.
9176 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009177
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009178 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9179 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9180
9181 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9182 extraction.
9183
9184
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009185tcp-check connect [params*]
9186 Opens a new connection
9187 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9188 no | no | yes | yes
9189
9190 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9191 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9192 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9193
9194 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9195 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9196 of the sequence.
9197
9198 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9199 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9200 do.
9201
9202 Parameters :
9203 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9204 use the TCP connection.
9205
9206 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9207 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9208 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9209
9210 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9211
9212 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9213
9214 Examples:
9215 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9216 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9217 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9218 option tcp-check
9219 tcp-check connect
9220 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9221 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9222 tcp-check send \r\n
9223 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9224 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9225 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9226 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9227 tcp-check send \r\n
9228 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9229 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9230
9231 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9232 option tcp-check
9233 tcp-check connect port 110
9234 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9235 tcp-check connect port 143
9236 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9237 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9238
9239 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9240
9241
9242tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009243 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009244 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9245 no | no | yes | yes
9246
9247 Arguments :
9248 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9249 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9250 binary.
9251 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9252 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9253 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9254
9255 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9256 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9257 with the usual backslash ('\').
9258 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009259 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009260 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9261 used upper or lower case.
9262
9263
9264 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9265
9266 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9267 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9268 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9269 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9270 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9271 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9272 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9273 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9274
9275 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9276 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9277 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9278 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9279 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9280 expression.
9281
9282 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9283 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9284 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9285 this exact hexadecimal string.
9286 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9287
9288 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9289 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9290 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9291 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9292 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9293 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9294 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9295 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9296 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9297 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9298 the null character.
9299
9300 Examples :
9301 # perform a POP check
9302 option tcp-check
9303 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9304
9305 # perform an IMAP check
9306 option tcp-check
9307 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9308
9309 # look for the redis master server
9310 option tcp-check
9311 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009312 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009313 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9314 tcp-check expect string role:master
9315 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9316 tcp-check expect string +OK
9317
9318
9319 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9320 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9321
9322
9323tcp-check send <data>
9324 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9325 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9326 no | no | yes | yes
9327
9328 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9329 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9330
9331 Examples :
9332 # look for the redis master server
9333 option tcp-check
9334 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9335 tcp-check expect string role:master
9336
9337 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9338 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9339
9340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009341tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9342 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009343 tcp health check
9344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9345 no | no | yes | yes
9346
9347 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9348 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009349 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009350 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9351 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9352 hexadecimal string.
9353 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9354
9355 Examples :
9356 # redis check in binary
9357 option tcp-check
9358 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9359 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9360
9361
9362 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9363 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9364
9365
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009366tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9367 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9369 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009370 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009371 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9372 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009373
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009374 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009375
9376 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9377 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009378 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9379 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9380 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9381 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9382 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9383 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009385 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9386 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9387 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9388 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009389
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009390 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009391 - accept :
9392 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9393 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9394 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009395
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009396 - reject :
9397 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9398 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9399 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9400 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9401 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9402 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9403 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9404 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9405 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9406 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9407 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009408 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009409
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009410 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9411 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9412 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9413 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9414 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9415 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9416 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9417 hosts.
9418
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009419 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9420 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9421 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9422 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9423 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9424 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9425 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9426 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9427
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009428 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9429 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9430 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9431 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9432 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9433 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9434 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9435 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9436 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009437 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9438 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009439
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009440 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009441 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009442 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9443 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9444 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009445 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009446 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9447 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9448 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9449 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9450 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9451 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9452 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9453 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009454
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009455 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009456 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009457 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009458 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009459 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9460 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9461 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009463 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9464 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9465 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9466 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009467
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009468 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9469 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9470 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9471 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9472 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009473 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9474 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9475 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9476 layer7 information is extracted.
9477
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009478 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9479 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9480 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9481 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9482 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009483
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009484 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9485 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9486 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9487 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9488
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009489 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9490 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9491 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9492 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9493
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009494 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9495 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9496 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9497 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9498 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009499
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009500 - set-src <expr> :
9501 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9502 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9503 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009504 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009505
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009506 Arguments:
9507 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9508 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009509
9510 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009511 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9512
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009513 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9514 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009515
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009516 - set-src-port <expr> :
9517 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9518 expression.
9519
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009520 Arguments:
9521 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9522 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009523
9524 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009525 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9526
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009527 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9528 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9529 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009530
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009531 - set-dst <expr> :
9532 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9533 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9534 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9535 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9536 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9537
9538 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9539 followed by some converters.
9540
9541 Example:
9542
9543 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9544 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9545
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009546 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9547 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9548
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009549 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9550 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9551 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9552 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9553
9554
9555 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9556 followed by some converters.
9557
9558 Example:
9559
9560 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9561
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009562 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9563 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9564 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9565
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009566 - "silent-drop" :
9567 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009568 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009569 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9570 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9571 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9572 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9573 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009574 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9575 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009576 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9577 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009578 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009579 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9580 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9581 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9582 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9583
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009584 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9585 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9586 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009587
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009588 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9589 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9590 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009591
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009592 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009593 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009594 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009595
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009596 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9597 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9598 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009600 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009601 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9602 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009603
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009604 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9605
9606 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9607
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009608 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9609
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009610 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009611
9612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009613tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9614 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009616 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009617 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009618 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9619 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009620
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009621 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009622
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009623 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009624 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9625 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9626 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9627 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009628
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009629 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9630 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9631 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9632 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009633 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9634 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9635 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9636 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9637 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9638 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009639 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009640 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009641
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009642 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9643 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9644 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9645 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009646
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009647 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009648 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009649 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009650 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9651 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009652 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009653 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009654 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009655 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009656 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009657 - set-dst <expr>
9658 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009659 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009660 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009661 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009662 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009663 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009664
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009665 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9666 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009667 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9668 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009669
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009670 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9671 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9672 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9673 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9674 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9675 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009677 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009678 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9679 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009680
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009681 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009682 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9683 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9684 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9685 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009686 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9687 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9688 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009689
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009690 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009691 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9692 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9693 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009694
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009695 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9696 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9697
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009698 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009699 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9700 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009701
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009702 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9703 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009704 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009705 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9706 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009707 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009708 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009709 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009710 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9711 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009712 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009713 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9714 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009715
9716 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9717 followed by some converters.
9718
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009719 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9720 <var-name>.
9721
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009722 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9723 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9724 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9725 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9726 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9727
9728 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9729 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9730 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9731 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9732 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9733 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9734 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9735 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9736 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9737 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9738 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9739
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009740 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9741 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9742 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9743 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9744 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9745
9746 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9747
9748 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9749
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009750 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9751 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9752 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9753 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9754 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9755 evaluated.
9756
9757 Example:
9758 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9759
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009760 Example:
9761
9762 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009763 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009764
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009765 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009766 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9767 # and reject everything else.
9768 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9769 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009770 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009771 tcp-request content reject
9772
9773 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009774 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9775 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9776 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009777 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009778
9779 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9780 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9781 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009782 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009783 tcp-request content reject
9784
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009785 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009786 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009787 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009788 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009789 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9790 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009791
9792 Example:
9793 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9794 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009795 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009796
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009797 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009798 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009799
9800 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009801 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009802 # protecting all our sites
9803 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009804 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9805 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009806 ...
9807 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9808
9809 backend http_dynamic
9810 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009811 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009812 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009813 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009814 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009815 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009816 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009818 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009819
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009820 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9821 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009822
9823
9824tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9825 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009827 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009828 Arguments :
9829 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9830 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9831 as explained at the top of this document.
9832
9833 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9834 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9835 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9836 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9837 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9838
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009839 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9840 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9841 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9842 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9843
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009844 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9845 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009846 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009847 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009848 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9849 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9850 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9851 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009852
9853 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9854 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9855 it pass through unaffected.
9856
9857 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9858 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9859 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009860 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009861 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9862 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009863 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9864 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9865 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009866
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009867 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009868 "timeout client".
9869
9870
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009871tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9872 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9874 no | no | yes | yes
9875 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009876 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9877 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009878
9879 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9880
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009881 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009882 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9883 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009884 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9885 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009886
9887 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9888
9889 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9890 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9891 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9892 inserted.
9893
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009894 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009895 - accept :
9896 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9897 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9898 the rules evaluation.
9899
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009900 - close :
9901 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9902 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9903 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9904 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9905 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9906 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009907 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009908 protocols.
9909
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009910 - reject :
9911 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9912 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009913 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009914
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009915 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9916 Sets a variable.
9917
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009918 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9919 Unsets a variable.
9920
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009921 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9922 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9923 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9924 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9925
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009926 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9927 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9928 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9929 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9930
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009931 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
9932 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9933 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9934 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9935 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009936
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009937 - "silent-drop" :
9938 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009939 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009940 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9941 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9942 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9943 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9944 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009945 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9946 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009947 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9948 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009949 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009950 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9951 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9952 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9953 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9954
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009955 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9956 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9957
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009958 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9959 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9960 for changing the default action to a reject.
9961
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009962 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9963 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9964 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9965 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009966 period.
9967
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009968 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9969 declared inline.
9970
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009971 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9972 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009973 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009974 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9975 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009976 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009977 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009978 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009979 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9980 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009981 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009982 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9983 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009984
9985 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9986 followed by some converters.
9987
9988 Example:
9989
9990 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9991
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009992 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9993 <var-name>.
9994
9995 Example:
9996
9997 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9998
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009999 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10000 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10001 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10002 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10003 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10004
10005 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10006
10007 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10008
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010009 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10010
10011 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10012
10013
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010014tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10015 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10017 no | yes | yes | no
10018 Arguments :
10019 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10020 below.
10021
10022 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10023
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010024 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010025 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10026 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10027 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10028 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10029 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10030 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10031 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010032 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010033 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10034 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10035 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10036 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10037 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10038 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10039 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10040 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10041 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10042 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10043 instead.
10044
10045 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10046 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10047 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10048 rules which may be inserted.
10049
10050 Several types of actions are supported :
10051 - accept : the request is accepted
10052 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10053 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10054 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010055 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010056 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010057 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010058 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010059 - silent-drop
10060
10061 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10062 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10063 sections for a complete description.
10064
10065 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10066 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10067 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10068
10069 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10070 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10071 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10072 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10073 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10074
10075 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10076 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10077
10078 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10079 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10080 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10081
10082 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10083 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10084 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10085
10086 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10087 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10088 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10089
10090 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10091 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10092 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10093
10094 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10095
10096 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10097
10098
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010099tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10100 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10102 no | no | yes | yes
10103 Arguments :
10104 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10105 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10106 as explained at the top of this document.
10107
10108 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10109
10110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010111timeout check <timeout>
10112 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10113 established.
10114
10115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10116 yes | no | yes | yes
10117 Arguments:
10118 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10119 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10120 as explained at the top of this document.
10121
10122 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10123 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010124 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010125 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010126 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10127 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10128 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010129
10130 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10131 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10132
10133 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10134 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010135 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010136
10137 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10138 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10139 forget about it.
10140
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010141 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10142 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010143
10144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010145timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010146 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10148 yes | yes | yes | no
10149 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010150 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010151 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10152 as explained at the top of this document.
10153
10154 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10155 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10156 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010157 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10158 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10159 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10160 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010161 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10162 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10163 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010164 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010165 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010166 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10167 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010168 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10169 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010170
10171 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10172 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10173 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10174 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010175 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010176 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010178 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010179
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010180 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010181
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010182
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010183timeout client-fin <timeout>
10184 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10186 yes | yes | yes | no
10187 Arguments :
10188 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10189 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10190 as explained at the top of this document.
10191
10192 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10193 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10194 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10195 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10196 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10197 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10198 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010199 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10200 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10201 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010202
10203 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10204 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10205 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10206
10207 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10208
10209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010210timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010211 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10213 yes | no | yes | yes
10214 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010215 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010216 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10217 as explained at the top of this document.
10218
10219 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010220 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010221 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010222 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010223 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10224 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010225
10226 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10227 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10228 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10229 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010230 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010231 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10232
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010233 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010235
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010236timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10237 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10239 yes | yes | yes | yes
10240 Arguments :
10241 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10242 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10243 as explained at the top of this document.
10244
10245 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10246 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10247 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10248 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10249 once the request has started to present itself.
10250
10251 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10252 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10253 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10254 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10255 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10256
10257 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10258 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10259 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10260 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10261
10262 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10263 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010264 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010265 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10266 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010267 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010268
10269 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10270 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10271 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10272 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010274 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10275 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010276 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10277
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010278 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10279
10280
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010281timeout http-request <timeout>
10282 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010284 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010285 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010286 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010287 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10288 as explained at the top of this document.
10289
10290 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10291 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10292 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10293 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10294 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10295 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10296 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010297 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10298 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10299 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10300 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010301 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010302 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10303 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010304
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010305 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10306 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10307 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10308 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10309 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010310 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010311
10312 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10313 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010314 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010315 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10316 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10317
10318 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010319 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10320 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10321 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010322
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010323 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010324 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010325
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010326
10327timeout queue <timeout>
10328 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10330 yes | no | yes | yes
10331 Arguments :
10332 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10333 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10334 as explained at the top of this document.
10335
10336 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10337 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10338 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10339 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10340 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10341
10342 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10343 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10344 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10345 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10346
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010347 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010348
10349
10350timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010351 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10353 yes | no | yes | yes
10354 Arguments :
10355 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10356 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10357 as explained at the top of this document.
10358
10359 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10360 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10361 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10362 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10363 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10364 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10365 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10366
10367 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10368 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10369 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10370 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10371 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010372 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010373 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010374 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10375 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010376 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10377 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010378
10379 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10380 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10381 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10382 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010383 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010384 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10385
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010386 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010387
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010388
10389timeout server-fin <timeout>
10390 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10392 yes | no | yes | yes
10393 Arguments :
10394 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10395 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10396 as explained at the top of this document.
10397
10398 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10399 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10400 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10401 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10402 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10403 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10404 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10405 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10406 situations, it should not be needed.
10407
10408 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10409 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10410 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10411
10412 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10413
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010414
10415timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010416 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10418 yes | yes | yes | yes
10419 Arguments :
10420 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10421 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10422 as explained at the top of this document.
10423
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010424 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10425 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10426 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010427
10428 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10429 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10430 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10431 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010432 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010433
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010434 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010435
10436
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010437timeout tunnel <timeout>
10438 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10440 yes | no | yes | yes
10441 Arguments :
10442 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10443 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10444 as explained at the top of this document.
10445
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010446 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010447 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10448 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10449 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010450 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10451 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010452 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10453 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10454 specified.
10455
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010456 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10457 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10458 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10459 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10460 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10461 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10462 state.
10463
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010464 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10465 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10466 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10467 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010468 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010469
10470 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10471 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10472 forget about it.
10473
10474 Example :
10475 defaults http
10476 option http-server-close
10477 timeout connect 5s
10478 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010479 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010480 timeout server 30s
10481 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10482
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010483 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010484
10485
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010486transparent (deprecated)
10487 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010489 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010490 Arguments : none
10491
10492 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10493 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10494 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10495 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10496 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10497 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10498 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10499 appropriate server.
10500
10501 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10502
10503 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10504 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10505
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010506 See also: "option transparent"
10507
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010508unique-id-format <string>
10509 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10511 yes | yes | yes | no
10512 Arguments :
10513 <string> is a log-format string.
10514
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010515 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10516 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10517 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10518 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010519
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010520 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10521 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10522 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10523 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10524 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10525 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10526 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10527 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010528
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010529 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10530 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010531
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010532 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010533
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010534 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010535
10536 will generate:
10537
10538 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10539
10540 See also: "unique-id-header"
10541
10542unique-id-header <name>
10543 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10545 yes | yes | yes | no
10546 Arguments :
10547 <name> is the name of the header.
10548
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010549 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10550 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010551
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010552 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010553
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010554 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010555 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10556
10557 will generate:
10558
10559 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10560
10561 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010562
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010563use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010564 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10566 no | yes | yes | no
10567 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010568 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10569 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010570
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010571 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10572 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010573
10574 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10575 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10576 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010577 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010578 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010579 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10580 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010581
10582 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10583 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10584 assign the backend.
10585
10586 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10587 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10588 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10589 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10590 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10591 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10592
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010593 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010594 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010595 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10596 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10597 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10598
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010599 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10600 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10601 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10602 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10603 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10604 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10605 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10606 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10607 cannot be forced from the request.
10608
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010609 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010610 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10611 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10612
10613 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10614 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010615
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010616use-fcgi-app <name>
10617 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10619 no | no | yes | yes
10620 Arguments :
10621 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10622
10623 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010624
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010625use-server <server> if <condition>
10626use-server <server> unless <condition>
10627 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10629 no | no | yes | yes
10630 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010631 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010632
10633 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10634
10635 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10636 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10637 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10638
10639 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10640 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10641 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10642 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10643 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10644 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10645 matches will assign the server.
10646
10647 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10648 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10649 with the next rules until one matches.
10650
10651 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10652 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10653 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10654 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10655
10656 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10657 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10658 stripped.
10659
10660 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10661 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10662 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10663 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10664
10665 Example :
10666 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10667 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10668 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10669 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10670 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10671 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010672 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010673 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10674 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10675
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010676 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010678
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100106795. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010680--------------------------
10681
10682The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10683depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10684settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10685written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10686described in this section.
10687
10688
106895.1. Bind options
10690-----------------
10691
10692The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10693as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10694no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10695parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10696while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10697provided immediately after the setting name.
10698
10699The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10700
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010701accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10702 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10703 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10704 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10705 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10706 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10707 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10708 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10709 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10710 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010711 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10712 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10713 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010714
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010715accept-proxy
10716 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010717 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10718 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010719 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10720 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10721 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10722 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010723 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010724 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10725 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010726 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10727 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010728
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010729allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010730 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010731 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010732 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010733 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10734 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010735
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010736alpn <protocols>
10737 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10738 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10739 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010740 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010741 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010742 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10743 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10744 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10745 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10746 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10747 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10748 preference, like below :
10749
10750 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010751
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010752backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010753 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010754 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10755
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010756curves <curves>
10757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10758 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10759 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10760 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10761 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10762 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10763
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010764ecdhe <named curve>
10765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010766 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10767 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010768
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010769ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10771 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10772 client's certificate.
10773
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010774ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10776 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10777 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10778 error is ignored.
10779
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010780ca-sign-file <cafile>
10781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10782 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10783 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10784 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10785 'generate-certificates' for details.
10786
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010787ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010788 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10789 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10790 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10791 'generate-certificates' for details.
10792
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010793ciphers <ciphers>
10794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10795 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010796 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010797 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010798 information and recommendations see e.g.
10799 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10800 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10801 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10802
10803ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10805 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10806 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10807 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010808 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10809 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010810
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010811crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10813 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10814 to verify client's certificate.
10815
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010816crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10818 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10819 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10820 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10821 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10822 file.
10823
10824 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10825 are loaded.
10826
10827 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010828 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010829 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10830 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10831 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10832 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010833 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10834 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010835 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010836
10837 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10838 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10839 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10840 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010841 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10842 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010843
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010844 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010845
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010846 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010847 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010848 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10849 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010850 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10851 clients).
10852
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010853 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10854 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10855 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10856 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10857 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10858 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10859 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10860 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10861 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10862 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10863 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10864 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10865 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10866
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010867 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10868 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10869 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10870 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10871 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10872
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010873 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10874 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10875 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10876 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010877
10878 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10879 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10880 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10881 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10882 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10883 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10884 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10885 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10886 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10887
10888 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10889
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010890 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010891 a cert bundle.
10892
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010893 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010894 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10895 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10896 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10897 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10898 provide multi-cert support.
10899
10900 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10901
10902 Filename | CN | SAN
10903 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10904 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010905 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010906 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10907 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10908
10909 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10910 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10911 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10912 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010913 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10914 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10915 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010916
10917 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10918 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10919
10920 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10921 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10922 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10923
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010924crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010926 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010927 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010928 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010929
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010930crt-list <file>
10931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010932 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10933 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010934
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010935 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10936
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010937 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10938 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010939 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010940 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010941
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010942 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10943 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10944 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10945 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10946 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10947 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10948 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10949 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010950
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010951 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010952 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010953 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10954 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10955 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010956
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010957 crt-list file example:
10958 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010959 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010960 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010961 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010962
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010963defer-accept
10964 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10965 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10966 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010967 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010968 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10969 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10970 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10971 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10972 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10973 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10974 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10975
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010976expose-fd listeners
10977 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10978 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010979 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10980 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010981 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010982
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010983force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010984 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010985 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010986 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010987 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010988
10989force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010990 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010991 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010992 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010993
10994force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010995 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010996 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010997 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010998
10999force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011000 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011001 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011002 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011003
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011004force-tlsv13
11005 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11006 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011007 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011008
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011009generate-certificates
11010 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11011 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11012 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11013 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11014 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11015 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11016 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11017 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11018 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11019 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11020 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11021
11022 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11023 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011024 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011025 certificate is used many times.
11026
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011027gid <gid>
11028 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11029 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11030 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11031 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11032 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11033
11034group <group>
11035 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11036 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11037 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11038 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11039 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11040
11041id <id>
11042 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11043 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11044 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11045 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11046
11047interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011048 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11049 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11050 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11051 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11052 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11053 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011054 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11055 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11056 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11057 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11058 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11059 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011060
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011061level <level>
11062 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11063 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11064 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011065 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011066 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11067 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11068 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011069 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011070 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011071 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011072 all counters).
11073
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011074severity-output <format>
11075 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11076 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11077 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11078 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11079 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11080 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11081 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11082 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11083 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11084 rfc5424 convention.
11085
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011086maxconn <maxconn>
11087 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11088 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11089 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11090 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11091 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11092 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11093 eat all memory.
11094
11095mode <mode>
11096 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11097 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11098 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11099 UNIX sockets.
11100
11101mss <maxseg>
11102 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11103 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11104 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11105 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11106 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11107 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11108 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11109 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11110 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11111 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11112 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11113
11114name <name>
11115 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11116 page.
11117
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011118namespace <name>
11119 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11120 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11121 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11122 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11123
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011124nice <nice>
11125 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11126 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11127 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11128 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11129 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11130 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11131 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11132 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11133 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11134 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11135 one for an RDP socket.
11136
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011137no-ca-names
11138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11139 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11140
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011141no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011143 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011144 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011145 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011146 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11147 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011148
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011149no-tls-tickets
11150 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11151 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11152 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011153 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11154 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011155
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011156no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011158 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011159 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011160 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011161 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11162 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011163
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011164no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011166 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011167 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011168 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011169 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11170 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011171
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011172no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011174 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011175 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011176 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011177 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11178 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011179
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011180no-tlsv13
11181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11182 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11183 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11184 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011185 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11186 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011187
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011188npn <protocols>
11189 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11190 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11191 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011192 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011193 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011194 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11195 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11196 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11197 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11198 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011199
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011200prefer-client-ciphers
11201 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11202 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11203 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011204 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11205 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11206 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011207
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011208process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011209 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011210 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011211 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011212 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11213 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11214 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11215 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011216 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011217 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11218 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11219 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11220 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11221 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011222
11223 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11224
11225 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11226 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11227 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11228 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11229 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11230 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11231 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11232 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011233
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011234proto <name>
11235 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11236 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11237 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11238 in haproxy -vv.
11239 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11240 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011241 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011242 h2" on the bind line.
11243
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011244ssl
11245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011246 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011247 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11248 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011249 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11250 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011251
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011252ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11253 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11254 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11255 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11256
11257ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11258 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11259 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11260 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11261
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011262strict-sni
11263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11264 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11265 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11266 See the "crt" option for more information.
11267
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011268tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011269 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011270 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11271 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011272 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011273 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11274 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11275 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11276 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11277 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11278 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11279 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11280
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011281tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011282 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011283 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11284 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11285 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11286 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11287 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11288 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11289 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011290 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11291 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11292 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011293
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011294tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11295 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011296 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11297 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11298 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11299 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11300 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11301 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11302 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11303 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11304 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11305 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011306 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11307 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11308
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011309transparent
11310 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11311 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11312 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11313 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11314 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11315 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11316 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11317 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11318 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11319 so check for support with your vendor.
11320
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011321v4v6
11322 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11323 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11324 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11325 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011326 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011327
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011328v6only
11329 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11330 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11331 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011332 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11333 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011334
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011335uid <uid>
11336 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11337 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11338 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11339 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11340 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11341
11342user <user>
11343 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11344 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11345 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11346 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11347 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11348
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011349verify [none|optional|required]
11350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11351 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11352 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11353 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11354 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011355 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11356 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11357 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11358 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113605.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011361------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011363The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11364which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11365arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11366settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11367after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11368Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11369address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011371 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011372 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011373
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011374Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11375keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011377The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011378
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011379addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011380 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011381 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11382 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11383 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11384 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11385 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011386
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011387agent-check
11388 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011389 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011390 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11391 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11392 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011393
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011394 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011395 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011396 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11397 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11398 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011399
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011400 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11401 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11402 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11403 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11404 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011405
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011406 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011407 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011408
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011409 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11410 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11411 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011412
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011413 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11414 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11415 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011416
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011417 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11418 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11419 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11420 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11421 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011422 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011423 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011424
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011425 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11426 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011427
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011428 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11429 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11430 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11431 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11432 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11433 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11434 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11435 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11436 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011437
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011438 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11439 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011440 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11441 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11442 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011443 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011444
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011445 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011446 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011447
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011448agent-send <string>
11449 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11450 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11451 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11452 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11453 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11454
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011455agent-inter <delay>
11456 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11457 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11458
11459 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11460 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11461 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11462 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11463 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11464 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11465 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11466 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11467 of backends use the same servers.
11468
11469 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11470
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011471agent-addr <addr>
11472 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11473
11474 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11475 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11476 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11477 hostname, it will be resolved.
11478
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011479agent-port <port>
11480 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11481
11482 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11483
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011484allow-0rtt
11485 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011486 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11487 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011488
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011489alpn <protocols>
11490 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11491 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11492 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011493 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011494 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11495 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11496 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11497 now obsolete NPN extension.
11498 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11499 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11500
11501 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011503backup
11504 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11505 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11506 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11507 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011508 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11509 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011510
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011511ca-file <cafile>
11512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11513 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11514 server's certificate.
11515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011516check
11517 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011518 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11519 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11520 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11521 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11522 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11523 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11524 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011525 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11526 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011527 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11528 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011529
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011530check-send-proxy
11531 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11532 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11533 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11534 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11535 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11536 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11537 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11538
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011539check-alpn <protocols>
11540 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11541 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11542 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11543
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011544check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011545 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011546 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11547 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011548
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011549check-ssl
11550 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11551 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11552 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11553 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011554 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011555 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11556 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011557 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011558 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11559 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011560
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011561check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011562 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011563 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11564 for normal traffic.
11565
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011566ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11568 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11569 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011570 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11571 information and recommendations see e.g.
11572 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11573 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11574 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011575
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011576ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11578 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11579 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11580 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011581 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11582 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11583 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011585cookie <value>
11586 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11587 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11588 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11589 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11590 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11591 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11592 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11593
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011594crl-file <crlfile>
11595 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11596 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11597 to verify server's certificate.
11598
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011599crt <cert>
11600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11601 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11602 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11603 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11604 certificate request.
11605
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011606disabled
11607 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11608 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11609 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11610 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11611 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011612 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011613
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011614enabled
11615 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11616 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11617 default value.
11618 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11619 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011621error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011622 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11623 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11624 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011626 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011628fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011629 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11630 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11631 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11632
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011633force-sslv3
11634 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11635 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011636 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011637 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011638
11639force-tlsv10
11640 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011641 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011642 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011643
11644force-tlsv11
11645 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011646 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011647 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011648
11649force-tlsv12
11650 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011651 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011652 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011653
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011654force-tlsv13
11655 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11656 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011657 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011659id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011660 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11661 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11662 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011663
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011664init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11665 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11666 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011667 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011668 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11669 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11670 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11671 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11672 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11673 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11674 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11675 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11676 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011677 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011678 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11679 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11680 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11681 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11682 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11683 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011684 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011685
11686 Example:
11687 defaults
11688 # never fail on address resolution
11689 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011691inter <delay>
11692fastinter <delay>
11693downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011694 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11695 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11696 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11697 between checks depending on the server state :
11698
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011699 Server state | Interval used
11700 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11701 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11702 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11703 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11704 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11705 or yet unchecked. |
11706 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11707 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11708 | "inter" otherwise.
11709 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011711 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11712 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11713 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11714 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011715 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11716 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11717 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11718 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11719 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011721maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011722 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11723 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011724 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11725 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011726 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11727 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11728 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11729 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11730
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011731 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11732 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11733 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11734 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11735 than 50 concurrent requests.
11736
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011737maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011738 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11739 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11740 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11741 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11742 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11743 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11744 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11745
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011746max-reuse <count>
11747 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11748 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11749 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11750 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11751 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11752 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11753 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11754 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011756minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011757 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11758 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11759 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11760 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11761 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11762 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011763 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011764 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011765
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011766namespace <name>
11767 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11768 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11769 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11770 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11771
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011772no-agent-check
11773 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11774 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11775 default value.
11776 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11777 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11778
11779no-backup
11780 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11781 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11782 default value.
11783 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11784 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11785
11786no-check
11787 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11788 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11789 default value.
11790 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11791 "default-server" "check" setting.
11792
11793no-check-ssl
11794 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11795 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11796 default value.
11797 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11798 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11799
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011800no-send-proxy
11801 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11802 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11803 default value.
11804 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11805 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11806
11807no-send-proxy-v2
11808 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11809 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11810 default value.
11811 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11812 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11813
11814no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11815 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11816 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11817 default value.
11818 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11819 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11820
11821no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11822 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11823 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11824 default value.
11825 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11826 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11827
11828no-ssl
11829 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11830 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11831 default value.
11832 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11833 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11834
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011835no-ssl-reuse
11836 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11837 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11838 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11839 and for paranoid users.
11840
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011841no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011842 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11843 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011844 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011845
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011846 Supported in default-server: No
11847
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011848no-tls-tickets
11849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11850 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11851 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011852 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11853 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011854 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011855
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011856no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011857 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011858 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11859 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011860 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11861 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011862 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011863
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011864 Supported in default-server: No
11865
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011866no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011867 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011868 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11869 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011870 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11871 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011872 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011873
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011874 Supported in default-server: No
11875
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011876no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011877 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011878 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11879 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011880 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11881 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011882 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011883
11884 Supported in default-server: No
11885
11886no-tlsv13
11887 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11888 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11889 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11890 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11891 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011892 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011893
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011894 Supported in default-server: No
11895
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011896no-verifyhost
11897 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11898 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11899 default value.
11900 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11901 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011902
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011903no-tfo
11904 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11905 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11906 default value.
11907 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11908 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11909
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011910non-stick
11911 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11912 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11913 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11914
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011915npn <protocols>
11916 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11917 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11918 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011919 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011920 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11921 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11922 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011924observe <mode>
11925 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11926 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11927 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11928 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11929 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11930 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011931 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011932
11933 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011935on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011936 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11937 Currently, four modes are available:
11938 - fastinter: force fastinter
11939 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11940 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11941 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11942 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11943
11944 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11945
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011946on-marked-down <action>
11947 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11948 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011949 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11950 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11951 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11952 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11953 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11954 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11955 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11956 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011957
11958 Actions are disabled by default
11959
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011960on-marked-up <action>
11961 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11962 Currently one action is available:
11963 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11964 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11965 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11966 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011967 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11968 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011969 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11970 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11971
11972 Actions are disabled by default
11973
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011974pool-max-conn <max>
11975 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11976 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11977 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11978 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11979 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11980 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11981
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011982pool-purge-delay <delay>
11983 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011984 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011985 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011987port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011988 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11989 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11990 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11991 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11992 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11993 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11994
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011995proto <name>
11996
11997 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11998 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11999 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12000 reported in haproxy -vv.
12001 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12002 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012004redir <prefix>
12005 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12006 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12007 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12008 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12009 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12010 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12011 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12012 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012013 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012014 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012015 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12016 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12017 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12018 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12019
12020 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012022rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012023 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12024 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12025 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12026
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012027resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12028 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12029 server.
12030
12031 Available options:
12032
12033 * allow-dup-ip
12034 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12035 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12036 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12037 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12038 For such case, simply enable this option.
12039 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12040
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012041 * ignore-weight
12042 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12043 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12044 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12045
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012046 * prevent-dup-ip
12047 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12048 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12049 same fqdn.
12050 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12051
12052 Example:
12053 backend b_myapp
12054 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12055 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12056 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12057
12058 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12059 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12060 it
12061 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12062 different address
12063
12064 Default value: not set
12065
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012066resolve-prefer <family>
12067 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12068 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12069 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12070 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12071
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012072 Default value: ipv6
12073
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012074 Example:
12075
12076 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012077
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012078resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012079 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012080 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012081 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012082 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12083 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012084 configured network, another address is selected.
12085
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012086 Example:
12087
12088 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012089
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012090resolvers <id>
12091 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12092 hostname.
12093
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012094 Example:
12095
12096 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012097
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012098 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012099
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012100send-proxy
12101 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12102 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12103 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12104 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012105 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12106 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12107 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12108 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12109 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12110 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12111 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12112 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12113 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12114 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012115 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12116 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012117
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012118send-proxy-v2
12119 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12120 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12121 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12122 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012123 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12124 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12125 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12126 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012127
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012128proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12129 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12130 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012131 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12132 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012133 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12134 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012135 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012136
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012137send-proxy-v2-ssl
12138 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12139 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12140 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12141 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12142 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12143 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12144 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012145 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12146 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012147
12148send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12149 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12150 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12151 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12152 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12153 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12154 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12155 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12156 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012157 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12158 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012160slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012161 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12162 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12163 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12164 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12165 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12166 parameters :
12167
12168 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12169 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12170
12171 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12172 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12173 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12174 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12175
12176 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12177 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12178 seen as failed.
12179
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012180sni <expression>
12181 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12182 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12183 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12184 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012185 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12186 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012187 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012188 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12189 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012190
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012191source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012192source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012193source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012194 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12195 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12196 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12197 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12198
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012199 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12200 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12201 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12202 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12203 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12204 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12205 server.
12206
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012207 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12208 specifying the source address without port(s).
12209
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012210ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012211 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12212 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12213 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12214 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12215 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12216 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012217 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12218 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012219
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012220ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12221 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12222 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12223 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12224
12225ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12226 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12227 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12228 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12229
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012230ssl-reuse
12231 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12232 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12233 default value.
12234 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12235 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12236
12237stick
12238 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12239 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12240 default value.
12241 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12242 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012243
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012244socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012245 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012246 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12247 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12248
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012249tcp-ut <delay>
12250 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12251 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12252 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012253 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012254 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12255 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12256 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12257 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12258 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12259 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12260 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12261 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12262 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12263
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012264tfo
12265 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12266 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12267 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12268 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12269 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012270 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012272track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012273 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12274 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12275 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12276 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012277 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12278
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012279tls-tickets
12280 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12281 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12282 default value.
12283 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12284 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012285
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012286verify [none|required]
12287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012288 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012289 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12290 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012291 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012292 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12293 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12294 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12295 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12296 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12297 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12298 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12299 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012300
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012301verifyhost <hostname>
12302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012303 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12304 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12305 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12306 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12307 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12308 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12309 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12310 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012312weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012313 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12314 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12315 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012316 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12317 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12318 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12319 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12320 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12321 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012322
12323
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123245.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12325-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012326
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012327HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12328using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12329configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012330This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12331can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12332workload.
12333This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12334resolution at run time.
12335Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12336carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12337
12338
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123395.3.1. Global overview
12340----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012341
12342As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12343different steps of the process life:
12344
12345 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12346 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12347 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12348
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012349 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12350 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012351
12352A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12353 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12354 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12355 resolution to know this new IP.
12356
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012357When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012358HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012359SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12360from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12361will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12362will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012363
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012364A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012365 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012366 first valid response.
12367
12368 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12369 servers return an error.
12370
12371
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123725.3.2. The resolvers section
12373----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012374
12375This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012376HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12377contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012378
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012379When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12380uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12381is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12382answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12383
12384When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012385used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012386
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012387 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12388 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12389 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012390
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012391 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12392 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012393
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012394 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12395 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12396 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012397
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012398For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12399following scenarios are possible:
12400
12401 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12402 ignored
12403
12404 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12405 applied
12406
12407 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12408 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12409
12410 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12411 retries the query with a new type
12412
12413 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12414 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012415
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012416As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12417a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012418<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012419
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012420
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012421resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012422 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012423
12424A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12425
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012426accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012427 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012428 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012429 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12430 by RFC 6891)
12431
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012432 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12433
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012434nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12435 DNS server description:
12436 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12437 <ip> : IP address of the server
12438 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12439
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012440parse-resolv-conf
12441 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12442 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12443 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12444
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012445hold <status> <period>
12446 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12447 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012448 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012449 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012450 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12451 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12452 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12453
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012454 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012455
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012456resolve_retries <nb>
12457 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12458 giving up.
12459 Default value: 3
12460
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012461 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12462 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12463 type.
12464
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012465timeout <event> <time>
12466 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12467 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12468 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012469 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12470 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012471 Default value: 1s
12472 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012473 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012474 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012475 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12476 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12477
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012478 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012479
12480 resolvers mydns
12481 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12482 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012483 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012484 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012485 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012486 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012487 hold other 30s
12488 hold refused 30s
12489 hold nx 30s
12490 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012491 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012492 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012493
12494
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200124956. Cache
12496---------
12497
12498HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12499(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12500RAM.
12501
12502The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12503this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12504
12505If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12506independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12507when we try to allocate a new one.
12508
12509The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12510
12511It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12512"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12513for more details.
12514
12515When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12516replaced by "<CACHE>".
12517
12518
125196.1. Limitation
12520----------------
12521
12522The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12523
12524- If the response is not a 200
12525- If the response contains a Vary header
12526- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12527- If the response is not cacheable
12528
12529- If the request is not a GET
12530- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12531- If the request contains an Authorization header
12532
12533
125346.2. Setup
12535-----------
12536
12537To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12538the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12539
12540
125416.2.1. Cache section
12542---------------------
12543
12544cache <name>
12545 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12546 size of cache is mandatory.
12547
12548total-max-size <megabytes>
12549 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12550 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12551
12552max-object-size <bytes>
12553 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12554 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12555 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12556
12557max-age <seconds>
12558 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12559 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12560 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12561 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12562 default.
12563
12564
125656.2.2. Proxy section
12566---------------------
12567
12568http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12569 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12570 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12571 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12572 after this one.
12573
12574http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12575 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12576 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12577 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12578 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12579
12580
12581Example:
12582
12583 backend bck1
12584 mode http
12585
12586 http-request cache-use foobar
12587 http-response cache-store foobar
12588 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12589
12590 cache foobar
12591 total-max-size 4
12592 max-age 240
12593
12594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125957. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12596----------------------------------
12597
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012598HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012599client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12600The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12601these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12602but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12603data called patterns.
12604
12605
126067.1. ACL basics
12607---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012608
12609The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12610content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12611from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12612simple :
12613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012614 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012615 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012616 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12617 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012619The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12620adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012621
12622In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012624 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012625
12626This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12627Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12628and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012629an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12630conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12631as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12632are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012633
12634ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12635'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12636which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12637
12638There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12639performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012641The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12642specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12643this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012644methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12645ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012646
12647Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12648 - boolean
12649 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12650 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12651 - string
12652 - data block
12653
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012654Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12655converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12656would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12657The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12658which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12659
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012660Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12661keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12662fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12663which are summarized in the table below :
12664
12665 +---------------------+-----------------+
12666 | Sample or converter | Default |
12667 | output type | matching method |
12668 +---------------------+-----------------+
12669 | boolean | bool |
12670 +---------------------+-----------------+
12671 | integer | int |
12672 +---------------------+-----------------+
12673 | ip | ip |
12674 +---------------------+-----------------+
12675 | string | str |
12676 +---------------------+-----------------+
12677 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12678 +---------------------+-----------------+
12679
12680Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12681matching method, see below.
12682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012683The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12684 - boolean
12685 - integer or integer range
12686 - IP address / network
12687 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12688 - regular expression
12689 - hex block
12690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012691The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12692
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012693 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12694 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012695 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012696 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012697 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012698 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012699 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12702read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12703if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12704lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12705will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12706beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12707a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12708lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12709exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12710
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012711The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12712parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12713ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12714a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12715check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12716
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012717The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12718socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12719file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012721Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12722loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12723
12724 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12725
12726In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12727the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12728case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12729as well.
12730
12731The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12732sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12733do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12734methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12735is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012736obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012737followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12738default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12739that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12740string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12741
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012742The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12743By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12744string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12745resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12746server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012747waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012748flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12749function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012751There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12752sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12753be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012754
12755 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12756 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012757 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12758 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12759 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12760 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012761
12762 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12763 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012765
12766 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012768
12769 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012770 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012771
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012772 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012773 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12774
12775 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12776 binary or string samples.
12777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012778 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12779 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012781 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12782 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12783 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012785 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12786 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012788 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12789 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012791 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12792 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12795 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012796 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012798 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12799 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12800 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012801
12802For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12803request, it is possible to do :
12804
12805 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12806
12807In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12808buffer, one would use the following acl :
12809
12810 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12811
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012812On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12813possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12814
12815 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12818criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12819method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12820to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12821criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12822the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012824If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012825the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12826For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012828 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12829 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12830 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12831 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012832
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012833
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012834The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12835types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12836combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12837brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12838default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012840 +-------------------------------------------------+
12841 | Input sample type |
12842 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012843 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012844 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12845 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12846 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012847 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012848 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012849 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012850 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012851 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012852 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012853 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012854 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012855 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012856 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012857 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012859 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012861 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012863 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012865 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012867 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12869 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012871
12872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128737.1.1. Matching booleans
12874------------------------
12875
12876In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12877Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12878When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12879that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12880
12881Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12882return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12883"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12884
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128867.1.2. Matching integers
12887------------------------
12888
12889Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12890enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12891to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12892
12893Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12894matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12895lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012896
12897For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12898unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12899representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12900
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012901As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12902two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12903instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12904ranges and operators.
12905
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012906For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012907operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12908Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12909of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012910
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012911Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012912
12913 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12914 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12915 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12916 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12917 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12918
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012919For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012920
12921 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12922
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012923This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12924
12925 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12926
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129287.1.3. Matching strings
12929-----------------------
12930
12931String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12932different forms :
12933
12934 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012935 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012936
12937 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012938 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012939
12940 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12941 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12942
12943 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12944 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12945
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012946 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012947 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12948 matches.
12949
12950 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12951 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12952 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012953
12954String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12955exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12956characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12957string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12958to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012959before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012960
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010012961Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
12962(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
12963Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
12964
12965Example:
12966 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
12967 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
12968
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129707.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12971---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012972
12973Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12974they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12975possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12976passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12977the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012978the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12979match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012980
12981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12983-------------------------------------
12984
12985It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12986not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12987a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12988to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12989digits may be used upper or lower case.
12990
12991Example :
12992 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12993 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12994
12995
129967.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12997---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012998
12999IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13000netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13001within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013002host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013003difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13004at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13005does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13006parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013007
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013008The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13009abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13010
13011 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13012 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13013 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13014 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13015 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13016 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13017 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13018 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13019
13020Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13021192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13022
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013023IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13024Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13025trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13026IPv6 patterns.
13027
13028HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13029following situations :
13030 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13031 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13032 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13033 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13034 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13035 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13036 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13037 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13038 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13039 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013041
130427.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13043----------------------------------
13044
13045Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13046combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13047
13048 - AND (implicit)
13049 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13050 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013052A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013054 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13057indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013059For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13060"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13061requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13062is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13063
13064 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013065 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13066 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13067 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013068
13069To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13070and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13071
13072 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13073 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13074 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13075 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13076
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013077 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013078 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13079 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13080 use_backend www if host_www
13081
13082It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13083expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13084be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13085the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13086
13087 The following rule :
13088
13089 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013090 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013091
13092 Can also be written that way :
13093
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013094 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095
13096It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13097to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13098simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13099sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13100good use is the following :
13101
13102 With named ACLs :
13103
13104 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13105 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13106 monitor fail if site_dead
13107
13108 With anonymous ACLs :
13109
13110 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13111
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013112See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13113keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114
13115
131167.3. Fetching samples
13117---------------------
13118
13119Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13120against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13121sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13122ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13123of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13124available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13125
13126This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13127Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13128compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13129deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13130
13131The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13132matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13133method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13134indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13135
13136As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13137when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13138mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13139the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13140ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13141
13142Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13143multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13144when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013145incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13146are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013147is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13148all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13149
13150Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13151 - name
13152 - name(arg1)
13153 - name(arg1,arg2)
13154
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013155
131567.3.1. Converters
13157-----------------
13158
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013159Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13160of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13161is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13162was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013163has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013164unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13165
13166These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13167sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13168the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013169support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013170
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013171A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13172support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13173supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13174(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13175bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013177The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013178
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001317951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13180 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13181 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13182 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13183 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13184 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13185
13186 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013187 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13188 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013189 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13190 frontend http-in
13191 bind *:8081
13192 default_backend servers
13193 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13194 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13195
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013196add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013197 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013198 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013199 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13200 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013201 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013202 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13203 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13204 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13205 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013206 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013207 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013208
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013209aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13210 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13211 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13212 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13213 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13214 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13215 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13216
13217 Example:
13218 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13219 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13220
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013221and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013222 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013223 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013224 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13225 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013226 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013227 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13228 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13229 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13230 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013231 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013232 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013233
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013234b64dec
13235 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13236 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13237
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013238base64
13239 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013240 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013241 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13242
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013243bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013244 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013245 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013246 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013247 presence of a flag).
13248
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013249bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13250 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13251 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013252 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013253
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013254concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13255 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13256 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13257 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13258 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13259 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13260 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13261 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13262 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13263 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13264 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013265 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013266 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013267 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013268
13269 Example:
13270 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13271 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13272 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13273 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13274
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013275cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013276 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13277 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013278
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013279crc32([<avalanche>])
13280 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13281 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13282 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13283 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13284 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13285 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13286 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13287 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13288 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13289 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013290 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13291
13292crc32c([<avalanche>])
13293 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13294 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13295 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13296 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13297 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13298 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13299 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13300 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013301
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013302da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013303 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13304 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13305 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13306 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013307 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013308 configuration language.
13309
13310 Example:
13311 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013312 bind *:8881
13313 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013314 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013315
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013316debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13317 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13318 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13319 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13320 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13321 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13322 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13323 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13324 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13325 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13326 printable sample types.
13327
13328 Example:
13329 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013330
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013331div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013332 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13333 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013334 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013335 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13336 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013337 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013338 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13339 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13340 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13341 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013342 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013343 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013344
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013345djb2([<avalanche>])
13346 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13347 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13348 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13349 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13350 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13351 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13352 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013353 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13354 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013355
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013356even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013357 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013358 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13359
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013360field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13361 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13362 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13363 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13364 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13365 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13366 fields.
13367
13368 Example :
13369 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13370 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13371 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13372 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13373 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013374
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013375hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013376 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013377 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013378 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013379 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013380
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013381hex2i
13382 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013383 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013384
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013385http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013386 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13387 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013388 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13389 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13390 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13391 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13392 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13393 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13394 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13395 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013396
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013397in_table(<table>)
13398 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13399 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13400 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013401 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013402 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13403
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013404ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13405 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013406 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013407 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13408 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13409 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13410 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13411 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013412
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013413json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013414 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013415 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013416 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013417 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13418 of errors:
13419 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13420 bytes, ...)
13421 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13422 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13423
13424 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13425 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13426 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13427 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13428 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13429 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013430 - "ascii" : never fails;
13431 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13432 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013433 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013434 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013435 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13436 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13437
13438 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013439 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013440
13441 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013442 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013443 capture request header user-agent len 150
13444 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013445
13446 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13447 GET / HTTP/1.0
13448 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13449
13450 Output log:
13451 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13452
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013453language(<value>[,<default>])
13454 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13455 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13456 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13457 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13458 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13459 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13460 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13461 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13462 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013463 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013464 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13465 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013466
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013467 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013468
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013469 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13470 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013471
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013472 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13473 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13474 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13475 use_backend spanish if es
13476 use_backend french if fr
13477 use_backend english if en
13478 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013479
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013480length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013481 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13482 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13483 type. The result is of type integer.
13484
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013485lower
13486 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13487 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13488 type. The result is of type string.
13489
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013490ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13491 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13492 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13493 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13494 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13495 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13496 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13497
13498 Example :
13499
13500 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013501 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013502 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13503
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013504map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13505map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13506map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13507 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13508 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13509 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13510 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13511 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13512 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13513 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13514 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013515
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013516 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13517 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13518 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013519
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013520 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013521 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013522
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013523 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13524 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13525 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13526 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013527 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13528 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013529 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13530 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13531 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13532 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13533 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13534 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13535 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13536 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013537 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13538 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13539 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013540 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13541 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13542 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13543 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13544 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013545
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013546 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13547 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13548 the corresponding match text.
13549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013550 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13551 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13552 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13553 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13554 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013555
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013556 Example :
13557
13558 # this is a comment and is ignored
13559 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13560 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13561 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13562 | | | `---------- value
13563 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13564 | `---------------------------- key
13565 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13566
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013567mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013568 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13569 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013570 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013571 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013572 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013573 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13574 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13575 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13576 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013577 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013578 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013579
13580mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013581 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013582 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13583 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013584 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013585 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013586 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013587 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13588 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13589 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13590 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013591 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013592 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013593
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013594nbsrv
13595 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13596 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13597 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13598 map lookup.
13599
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013600neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013601 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13602 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13603 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13604 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013605
13606not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013607 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013608 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013609 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013610 absence of a flag).
13611
13612odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013613 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013614 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13615
13616or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013617 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013618 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013619 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13620 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013621 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013622 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13623 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13624 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13625 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013626 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013627 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013628
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013629protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13630 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13631 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13632 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13633 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13634 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13635 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13636 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13637 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13638 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13639 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13640 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13641
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013642regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013643 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13644 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13645 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13646 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13647 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13648 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13649 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13650 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13651 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13652 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013653 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13654 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13655 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13656 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013657
13658 Example :
13659
13660 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13661 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13662 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13663 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13664
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013665capture-req(<id>)
13666 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13667 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13668
13669 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013670 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13671 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013672
13673capture-res(<id>)
13674 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13675 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13676
13677 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013678 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13679 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013680
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013681sdbm([<avalanche>])
13682 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13683 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13684 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13685 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13686 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13687 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13688 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013689 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13690 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013691
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013692set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013693 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13694 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13695 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013696 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013697 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13698 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013699 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013700 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13701 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013702 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013703 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013704
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013705sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013706 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013707 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13708
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013709sha2([<bits>])
13710 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13711 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13712
13713 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13714 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13715
13716 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13717 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13718
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013719srv_queue
13720 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13721 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13722 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13723 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13724 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13725
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013726strcmp(<var>)
13727 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13728 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13729 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13730 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13731 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13732 shorter).
13733
13734 Example :
13735
13736 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13737 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13738 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13739
13740
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013741sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013742 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13743 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013744 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013745 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13746 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013747 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013748 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13749 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013750 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013751 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13752 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013753 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013754 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013755
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013756table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13757 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13758 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13759 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13760 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13761 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13762 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13763
13764
13765table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13766 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13767 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13768 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13769 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13770 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13771 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13772
13773table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13774 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13775 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013776 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013777 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13778 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13779
13780table_conn_cur(<table>)
13781 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13782 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13783 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13784 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13785 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13786
13787table_conn_rate(<table>)
13788 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13789 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13790 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13791 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13792 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13793
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013794table_gpt0(<table>)
13795 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13796 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13797 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13798 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13799 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13800
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013801table_gpc0(<table>)
13802 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13803 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13804 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13805 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13806 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13807
13808table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13811 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13812 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13813 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13814 sample fetch keyword.
13815
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013816table_gpc1(<table>)
13817 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13818 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13819 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13820 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13821 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13822
13823table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13824 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13825 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13826 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13827 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13828 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13829 sample fetch keyword.
13830
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013831table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013835 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13836 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13837
13838table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13839 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13840 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13841 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13842 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13843 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13844 keyword.
13845
13846table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13847 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13848 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013849 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013850 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13851 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13852
13853table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13854 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13855 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13856 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13857 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13858 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13859 keyword.
13860
13861table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13862 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13863 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013865 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13866 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13867 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13868 keyword.
13869
13870table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13871 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13872 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013873 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013874 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13875 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13876 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13877 keyword.
13878
13879table_server_id(<table>)
13880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13883 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13884 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13885 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13886
13887table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013891 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13892 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13893 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13894 keyword.
13895
13896table_sess_rate(<table>)
13897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13900 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13901 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13902 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13903 keyword.
13904
13905table_trackers(<table>)
13906 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13907 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13908 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13909 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13910 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13911 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13912 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13913 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13914 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13915 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13916
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013917upper
13918 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13919 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13920 type. The result is of type string.
13921
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013922url_dec
13923 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13924 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13925
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013926ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013927 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013928 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13929 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13930 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013931 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13932 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13933 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13934 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013935 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013936 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13937 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013938
13939 Example:
13940 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13941 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13942
13943 message Point {
13944 int32 latitude = 1;
13945 int32 longitude = 2;
13946 }
13947
13948 message PPoint {
13949 Point point = 59;
13950 }
13951
13952 message Rectangle {
13953 // One corner of the rectangle.
13954 PPoint lo = 48;
13955 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13956 PPoint hi = 49;
13957 }
13958
13959 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13960 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13961 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13962
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013963 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13964 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013965 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013966 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13967
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013968 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013969
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013970 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013971
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013972 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013973 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13974 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13975
13976 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13977 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13978 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13979
13980 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13981 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13982 interpret the previous binary sample.
13983
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013984
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013985unset-var(<var name>)
13986 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13987 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13988 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13989 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13990 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13991 response),
13992 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13993 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13994 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13995 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13996
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013997utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13998 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13999 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14000 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14001 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14002 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14003 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14004
14005 Example :
14006
14007 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014008 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014009 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14010
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014011word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14012 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14013 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14014 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14015 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14016 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14017
14018 Example :
14019 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14020 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14021 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14022 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14023 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014024
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014025wt6([<avalanche>])
14026 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14027 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14028 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14029 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14030 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14031 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14032 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014033 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14034 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014035
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014036xor(<value>)
14037 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014038 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014039 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014040 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014041 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014042 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14043 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014044 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014045 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14046 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014047 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014048 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014049
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014050xxh32([<seed>])
14051 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14052 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14053 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14054 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14055 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14056 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14057 as cryptographically secure.
14058
14059xxh64([<seed>])
14060 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14061 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14062 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14063 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14064 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14065 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14066 as cryptographically secure.
14067
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014068
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140697.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070--------------------------------------------
14071
14072A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14073not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14074"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14075The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14076
14077always_false : boolean
14078 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14079 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14080
14081always_true : boolean
14082 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14083 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14084
14085avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014086 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14088 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14089 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14090 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14091 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14092 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14093 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14094 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14095 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14096 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14097 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14098 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14099 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014101be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014102 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14103 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14104 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14105 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014106 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14107
14108be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14109 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14110 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14111 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14112 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14113 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014114 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14115 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014116
14117 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14118 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14119 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14122 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14123 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14124 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014125 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14127 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014128
14129 Example :
14130 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14131 backend dynamic
14132 mode http
14133 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14134 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014136bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014137 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14138 of the string.
14139
14140bool(<bool>) : bool
14141 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14142 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14145 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014146 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014147 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14148 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014149
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014150 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014151 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014152 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14153
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014154 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14155 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014156
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014157 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014158 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014159 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014160 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014161 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014162 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014163 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014164
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014165 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14166 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014167 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014168 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014169
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014170cpu_calls : integer
14171 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14172 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14173 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14174 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14175 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14176 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14177
14178cpu_ns_avg : integer
14179 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14180 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14181 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14182 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14183 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14184 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14185 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14186 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14187 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14188 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14189 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14190
14191cpu_ns_tot : integer
14192 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14193 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14194 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14195 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14196 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14197 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14198 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14199 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14200 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14201 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14202 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14203 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14204 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14205
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014206date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014207 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014208
14209 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14210 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14211 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014212 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14213
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014214 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14215 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14216 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14217 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14218 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14219
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014220 Example :
14221
14222 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14223 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014224
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014225 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14226 # millisecond granularity
14227 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14228
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014229date_us : integer
14230 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14231 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14232 from the same timeval structure.
14233
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014234distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14235 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14236 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14237 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14238 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14239 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14240 list of supported tokens.
14241
14242distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14243 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14244 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14245 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14246 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14247 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14248 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14249 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14250 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14251 supported tokens.
14252
14253 Example :
14254 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14255 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14256 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14257 # send large files to the big farm
14258 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14259
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014260env(<name>) : string
14261 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14262 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14263 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14264 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14265 certain way.
14266
14267 Examples :
14268 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14269 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14270
14271 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14272 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014274fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14275 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014276 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14277 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14279 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014280 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014281 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14282 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014283
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014284fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14285 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14286 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14287 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014289fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14290 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14291 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14292 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14293 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14294 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14295 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14296 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14297 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014298
14299 Example :
14300 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14301 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14302 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14303 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14304 frontend mail
14305 bind :25
14306 mode tcp
14307 maxconn 100
14308 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14309 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14310 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14311 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014312
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014313hostname : string
14314 Returns the system hostname.
14315
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014316int(<integer>) : signed integer
14317 Returns a signed integer.
14318
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014319ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14320 Returns an ipv4.
14321
14322ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14323 Returns an ipv6.
14324
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014325lat_ns_avg : integer
14326 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14327 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14328 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14329 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14330 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14331 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14332 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14333 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14334 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14335 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14336 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14337 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14338 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14339 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14340
14341lat_ns_tot : integer
14342 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14343 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14344 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14345 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14346 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14347 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14348 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14349 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14350 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14351 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14352 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14353 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14354 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14355 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14356 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14357 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14358 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14359 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14360 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14361
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014362meth(<method>) : method
14363 Returns a method.
14364
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014365nbproc : integer
14366 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14367 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14368 and debugging purposes.
14369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014370nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14371 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14372 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14373 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014374 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14375 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14376 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014377
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014378prio_class : integer
14379 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14380 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14381 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14382
14383prio_offset : integer
14384 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14385 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14386 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14387 set-priority-offset".
14388
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014389proc : integer
14390 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14391 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14392 debugging purposes.
14393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014395 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14396 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14397 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14399 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14400 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14401 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14402 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14403
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014404rand([<range>]) : integer
14405 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14406 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14407 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14408 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14409 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14410
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014411uuid([<version>]) : string
14412 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14413 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14414 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014416srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14417 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14418 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14419 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14420 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14421 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014422 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14423 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14424
14425srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14426 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14427 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14428 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14429 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14430 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14431 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14432 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14433
14434 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14435 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014436
14437srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14438 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14439 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14440 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014441 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014442 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14443 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14444 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14445
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014446srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14447 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14448 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14449 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14450 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14451 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14452 fetch methods.
14453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014454srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14455 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14456 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014457 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014458 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14459 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014460 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014461 overloading servers).
14462
14463 Example :
14464 # Redirect to a separate back
14465 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14466 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14467 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14468
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014469stopping : boolean
14470 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14471 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14472 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14473
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014474str(<string>) : string
14475 Returns a string.
14476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14478 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14479 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14480
14481table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14482 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14483 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14484 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14485
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014486thread : integer
14487 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14488 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14489 and debugging purposes.
14490
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014491var(<var-name>) : undefined
14492 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014493 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14494 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014495 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014496 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14497 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014498 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014499 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14500 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014501 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014502 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014503
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145047.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505----------------------------------
14506
14507The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14508closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14509methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14510sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14511TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014512the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14513counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014514"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14515used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14516can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14517Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14518table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14519tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14520currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014521
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014522bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014523 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14524 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14525 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527be_id : integer
14528 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14529 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14530
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014531be_name : string
14532 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14533 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535dst : ip
14536 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14537 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14538 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14539 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014540 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14541 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14542 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14543 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14544 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14545 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014546
14547dst_conn : integer
14548 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14549 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14550 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14551 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14552 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14553 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14554 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14555 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014556
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014557dst_is_local : boolean
14558 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14559 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14560 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14561 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014562 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014563 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14564 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14565 it only once per connection.
14566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567dst_port : integer
14568 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14569 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14570 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14571 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14572 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14573 an HTTP header.
14574
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014575fc_http_major : integer
14576 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14577 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14578 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14579
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014580fc_pp_authority : string
14581 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14582 if any.
14583
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014584fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14585 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14586 header.
14587
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014588fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14589 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14590 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14591 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14592 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14593 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14594 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14595
14596fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14597 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14598 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14599 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14600 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14601 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14602 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14603
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014604fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014605 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14606 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14607 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14608 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14609
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014610fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014611 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14612 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14613 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14614 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14615
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014616fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014617 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14618 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14619 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14620 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14621
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014622fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014623 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14624 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14625 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14626 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14627
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014628fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014629 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14630 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14631 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14632 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14633
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014634fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014635 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14636 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14637 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14638 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14639
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014640fe_defbe : string
14641 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14642 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014644fe_id : integer
14645 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014646 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14648
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014649fe_name : string
14650 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14651 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14652 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14653
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014654sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014655sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14656sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14657sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014658 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14659 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14660 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14661
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014662sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014663sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14664sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14665sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014666 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14667 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14668 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14669
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014670sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014671sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14672sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14673sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014674 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14675 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014676 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14677 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14678 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014679
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014680 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014681 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14682 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014683 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14684 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14685 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014686 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14687 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14688
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014689sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14690sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14691sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14692sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14693 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14694 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14695 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14696 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14697 when a first ACL was verified.
14698
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014699sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014700sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14701sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14702sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014703 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014704 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14705
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014706sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014707sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14708sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14709sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014710 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14711 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14712 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14713
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014714sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014715sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14716sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14717sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014718 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14719 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14720 See also src_conn_rate.
14721
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014722sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014723sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14724sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14725sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014726 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014727 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014728
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014729sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14730sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14731sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14732sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14733 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14734 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14735
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014736sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14737sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14738sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14739sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14740 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14741 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014743sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014744sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14745sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14746sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014747 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14748 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14749 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014750 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14751 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14752 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014753
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014754sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14755sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14756sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14757sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14758 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14759 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14760 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14761 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14762 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14763 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14764
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014765sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014766sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14767sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14768sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014769 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014770 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14771 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14772
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014773sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014774sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14775sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14776sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014777 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14778 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14779 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14780 src_http_err_rate.
14781
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014782sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014783sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14784sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14785sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014786 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014787 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14788 src_http_req_cnt.
14789
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014790sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014791sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14792sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14793sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014794 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14795 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14796 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14797 src_http_req_rate.
14798
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014799sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014800sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14801sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14802sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014803 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014804 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14805 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14806 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14807 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014808
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014809 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014810 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14811 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014812 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14813
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014814sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14815sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14816sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14817sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14818 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14819 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14820 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14821 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14822 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14823
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014824sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014825sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14826sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14827sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014828 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14829 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14830 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014831
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014832sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014833sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14834sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14835sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014836 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14837 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14838 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014839
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014840sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014841sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14842sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14843sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014844 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014845 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14846 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14847 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014848 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014849 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14850
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014851sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014852sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14853sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14854sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014855 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14856 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14857 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14858 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14859 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014860 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014862sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014863sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14864sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14865sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014866 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14867 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14868 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14869
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014870sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014871sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14872sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14873sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014874 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14875 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014876 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014877 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14878 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014879 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14880 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14881 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883so_id : integer
14884 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14885 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14886 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014889 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14891 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14892 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014893 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14894 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14895 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014896 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14897 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14898 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14899 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14900 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14901 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14902 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014903
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014904 Example:
14905 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14906 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14909 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14910 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14911 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014912 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14915 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14916 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014917 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014918 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14921 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14922 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14923 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14924 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14925 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14926 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014927
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014928 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014929 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14930 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14931 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14932 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014933 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014934 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14935 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14936
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014937src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14938 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14939 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14940 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14941 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14942 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14943 was verified.
14944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014945src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014946 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014947 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014948 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014949 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014951src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014952 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14954 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014955 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14958 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14959 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14960 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014961 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014963src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014964 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014965 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014966 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014967 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014968
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014969src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14970 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14971 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14972 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14973 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14974
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014975src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14976 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14977 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14978 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14979 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014981src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014982 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014983 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014984 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14985 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014986 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14987 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14988 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014989
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014990src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14991 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14992 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14993 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14994 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14995 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14996 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14997 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015000 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015001 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015002 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015003 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015006src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15007 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15008 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15009 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15010 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015011 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015014 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15016 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015017 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015019src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15020 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15021 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15022 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015023 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015024 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15027 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15028 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15029 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015030 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15032 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015033
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015034 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015035 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015036 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015037 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015038
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015039src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15040 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15041 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15042 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15043 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15044 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15045 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15046
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015047src_is_local : boolean
15048 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15049 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15050 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15051 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015052 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015053 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15054 once per connection.
15055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015056src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015057 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15058 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15059 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15060 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15061 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015063src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015064 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15065 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15066 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15067 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15068 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015070src_port : integer
15071 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15072 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15073 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15074 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015077 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015078 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15079 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15080 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015081 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15084 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15085 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15086 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15087 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015088 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15091 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15092 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15093 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15094 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15095 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15096 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15097 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15098 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015099
15100 Example :
15101 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15102 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15103 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15104 listen ssh
15105 bind :22
15106 mode tcp
15107 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015108 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015110 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112srv_id : integer
15113 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15114 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15115 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015116
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015117srv_name : string
15118 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15119 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15120 debugging.
15121
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151227.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15126closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15127when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15128usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015129future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015130
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001513151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15132 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15133 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15134 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15135 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15136 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15137
15138 Example :
15139 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15140 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15141 # the request.
15142 frontend http-in
15143 bind *:8081
15144 default_backend servers
15145 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15146 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15147
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015148ssl_bc : boolean
15149 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15150 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15151 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15152
15153ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15154 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15155 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15156
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015157ssl_bc_alpn : string
15158 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15159 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015160 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015161 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15162 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15163 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15164 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15165 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15166 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15167
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015168ssl_bc_cipher : string
15169 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15170 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15171
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015172ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15173 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15174 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15175 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15176
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015177ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15178 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15179 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15180 session or a TLS ticket.
15181
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015182ssl_bc_npn : string
15183 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15184 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015185 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015186 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15187 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15188 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15189 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15190 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15191
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015192ssl_bc_protocol : string
15193 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15194 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15195
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015196ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015197 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015198 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15199 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015200
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015201ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15202 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15203 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15204 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15205
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015206ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15207 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15208 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15209 if session was reused or not.
15210
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015211ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15212 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15213 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15214 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15215 BoringSSL.
15216
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015217ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15218 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15219 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15222 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15223 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15224 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15225 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15226 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15229 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15230 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15231 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15232 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015233
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015234ssl_c_der : binary
15235 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15236 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15237 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015239ssl_c_err : integer
15240 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15241 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15242 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15243 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15244 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15247 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15248 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15249 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15250 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15251 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15252 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15253 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15254 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015256ssl_c_key_alg : string
15257 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15258 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15259 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261ssl_c_notafter : string
15262 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15263 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15264 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266ssl_c_notbefore : string
15267 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15268 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15269 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015271ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15272 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15273 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15274 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15275 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15276 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15277 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15278 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15279 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281ssl_c_serial : binary
15282 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15283 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15284 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015286ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15287 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15288 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15289 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015290 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15291 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15292
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015293 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015294 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015296ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15297 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15298 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15299 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015301ssl_c_used : boolean
15302 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15303 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305ssl_c_verify : integer
15306 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15307 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15308 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15309 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015311ssl_c_version : integer
15312 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15313 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015314
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015315ssl_f_der : binary
15316 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15317 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15318 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15321 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15322 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15323 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15324 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015325 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015326 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15327 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15328 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015330ssl_f_key_alg : string
15331 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15332 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15333 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335ssl_f_notafter : string
15336 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15337 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15338 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340ssl_f_notbefore : string
15341 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15342 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15343 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015345ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15346 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15347 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15348 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15349 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15350 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15351 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15352 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15353 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015355ssl_f_serial : binary
15356 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15357 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15358 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015359
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015360ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15361 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15362 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15363 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015365ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15366 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15367 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15368 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015370ssl_f_version : integer
15371 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15372 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15373
15374ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015375 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15376 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15377 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015379 Example :
15380 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15381 listen http-https
15382 bind :80
15383 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15384 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15385
15386ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15387 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15388 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15389
15390ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015391 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015392 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15393 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15394 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15395 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15396 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15397 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15398 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15399 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015401ssl_fc_cipher : string
15402 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15403 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015404
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015405ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15406 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15407 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015408 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015409
15410ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15411 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15412 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015413 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015414
15415ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15416 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15417 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15418 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015419 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015420 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015421
15422ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15423 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15424 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015425 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015426
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015427ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15428 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15429 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15430 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015433 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15434 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015435 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15436 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15437 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15438 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015439
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015440ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15441 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15442 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15443 wait until the handshake happened.
15444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015445ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15446 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015447 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15448 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015449 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015450 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015451
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015452ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015453 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015454 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15455 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015458 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15460 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15461 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15462 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15463 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15464 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15465 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467ssl_fc_protocol : string
15468 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15469 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015470
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015471ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015472 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015473 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15474 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015475
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015476ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15477 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15478 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15479 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15482 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15483 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15484 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15485 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015486
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015487ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15488 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15489 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15490 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15491 BoringSSL.
15492
15493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494ssl_fc_sni : string
15495 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15496 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15497 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15498 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15499 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15500
15501 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15502 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15503 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015504 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015505 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15509 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15512 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15513 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015514
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015515
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15520sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15521only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15522For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15523be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15524can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15525sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15526for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15527content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015530 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15532 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15535 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015536 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015538
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015539req.hdrs : string
15540 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15541 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15542 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15543 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15544
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015545req.hdrs_bin : binary
15546 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15547 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15548 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15549 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15550 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15551 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15552
15553 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15554
15555 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15556 str: <int:length><bytes>
15557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558req.len : integer
15559req_len : integer (deprecated)
15560 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15561 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15562 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15563 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15564 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15565 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15566 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15567 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15570 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015571 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15572 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15573 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15574 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576 ACL alternatives :
15577 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15580 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15581 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15582 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15583 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585 ACL alternatives :
15586 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590req.proto_http : boolean
15591req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15592 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15593 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15594 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15595 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15596 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15597 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15598 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 Example:
15601 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15602 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15603 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015604 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15607rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15608 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15609 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15610 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15611 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15612 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15613 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15614 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15617 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15618 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15619 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15620 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15621 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 ACL derivatives :
15624 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626 Example :
15627 listen tse-farm
15628 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15629 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15630 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15631 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15632 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15633 persist rdp-cookie
15634 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15635 # This is only useful makes sense if
15636 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15637 stick-table type string size 204800
15638 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15639 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15640 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015642 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15643 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15646rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15647 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15648 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15649 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15650 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652 ACL derivatives :
15653 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015654
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015655req.ssl_alpn : string
15656 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15657 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15658 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15659 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15660 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15661 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015662 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015663
15664 Examples :
15665 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15666 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15667 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015668 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015669 default_backend bk_default
15670
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015671req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15672 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15673 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015674 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15675 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15676 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15677 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15678 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15681req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15682 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15683 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15684 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15685 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15686 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15687 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15688 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690req.ssl_sni : string
15691req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15692 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15693 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15694 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15695 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15696 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15697 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15698 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15699 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15700 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15701 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15702 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15703 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 ACL derivatives :
15706 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708 Examples :
15709 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15710 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15711 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15712 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15713 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015714
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015715req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15716 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15717 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15718 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15719 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15720 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15721 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15722 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15723 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15724 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726req.ssl_ver : integer
15727req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15728 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15729 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15730 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15731 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15732 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15733 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15734 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015735 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738 ACL derivatives :
15739 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015740
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015741res.len : integer
15742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15743 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15744 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15745 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15746 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15747 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15748 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15749 content inspection.
15750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15752 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015753 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15754 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15755 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15756 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015758res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15759 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15760 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15761 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15762 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015764 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015765
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015766res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15767rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15768 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15769 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15770 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15771 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15772 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15773 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15774 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015776wait_end : boolean
15777 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15778 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015779 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15781 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015782 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015783 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15784 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786 Examples :
15787 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15788 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15789 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015791 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15792 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15793 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15794 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15795 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15796 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15797 tcp-request content reject
15798
15799
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158007.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801--------------------------------------
15802
15803It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15804This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15805data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15806its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15807HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15808content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15809to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15810more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15811response are indexed.
15812
15813base : string
15814 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15815 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15816 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15817 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15818 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15819 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15820 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15821 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15822
15823 ACL derivatives :
15824 base : exact string match
15825 base_beg : prefix match
15826 base_dir : subdir match
15827 base_dom : domain match
15828 base_end : suffix match
15829 base_len : length match
15830 base_reg : regex match
15831 base_sub : substring match
15832
15833base32 : integer
15834 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15835 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15836 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015837 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15838 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15839 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840
15841base32+src : binary
15842 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15843 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15844 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15845 per-URL counters.
15846
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015847capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15848 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15849 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15850 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15851
15852capture.req.method : string
15853 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15854 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15855 because it's allocated.
15856
15857capture.req.uri : string
15858 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15859 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15860 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15861 allocated.
15862
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015863capture.req.ver : string
15864 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15865 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15866 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15867
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015868capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15869 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15870 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15871 The first entry is an index of 0.
15872 See also: "capture response header"
15873
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015874capture.res.ver : string
15875 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15876 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15877 persistent flag.
15878
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015879req.body : binary
15880 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15881 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15882 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15883 the first chunk is analyzed.
15884
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015885req.body_param([<name>) : string
15886 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15887 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15888 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15889 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15890 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15891 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15892 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15893 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15894 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15895 given.
15896
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015897req.body_len : integer
15898 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15899 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15900 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15901 "option http-buffer-request".
15902
15903req.body_size : integer
15904 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15905 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15906 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15907 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15908 "option http-buffer-request".
15909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910req.cook([<name>]) : string
15911cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15912 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15913 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15914 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15915 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15916 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15917 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15918 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15919 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15920
15921 ACL derivatives :
15922 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15923 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15924 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15925 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15926 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15927 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15928 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15929 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15932cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15933 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15934 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15937cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15938 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15939 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15940 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15941 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15944 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15945 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15946 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15947 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015948 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15950 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15951 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15952 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15955 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15956 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15957 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15958 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015959 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015961req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15962 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15963 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15964 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15965 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15966 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15967 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15968 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15969 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015971req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15972 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15973 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15974 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15975 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15978 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15979 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15980 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15981 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15982 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15983 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15984 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15985 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015986 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015988 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990 ACL derivatives :
15991 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15992 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15993 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15994 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15995 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15996 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15997 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15998 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15999
16000req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16001hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16002 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16003 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16004 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16005 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16006 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16007 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16008 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16009 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16010 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16011
16012req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16013hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16014 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16015 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16016 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16017 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16018 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016019 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016020 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16021 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16022
16023req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16024hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16025 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16026 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16027 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16028 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16029 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16030 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16031 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16032
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016033
16034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16036 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16037 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16038 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16039 basic auth is supported.
16040
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016041http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16042 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16043 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16044 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16045 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16047 basic auth is supported.
16048
16049 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016050 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16051 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16052 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16053 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016055http_auth_pass : string
16056 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16057 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16058 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16059
16060http_auth_type : string
16061 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16062 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16063 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16064
16065http_auth_user : string
16066 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16067 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16068 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016071 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16072 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016073 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16074 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076method : integer + string
16077 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16078 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16079 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16080 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16081 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16082 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16083 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085 ACL derivatives :
16086 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016088 Example :
16089 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16090 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16091 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093path : string
16094 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16095 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16096 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16097 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16098 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016099 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102 ACL derivatives :
16103 path : exact string match
16104 path_beg : prefix match
16105 path_dir : subdir match
16106 path_dom : domain match
16107 path_end : suffix match
16108 path_len : length match
16109 path_reg : regex match
16110 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016111
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016112query : string
16113 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16114 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16115 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16116 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016117 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016118 which stops before the question mark.
16119
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016120req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16121 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16122 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16123 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16124 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126req.ver : string
16127req_ver : string (deprecated)
16128 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16129 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16130 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016132 ACL derivatives :
16133 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016135res.comp : boolean
16136 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16137 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16138 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016140res.comp_algo : string
16141 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16142 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16143 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145res.cook([<name>]) : string
16146scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16147 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16148 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16149 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151 ACL derivatives :
16152 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16155scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16156 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16157 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16158 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16161scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16162 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16163 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16164 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016166res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16167 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16168 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16169 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16170 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16171 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16172 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16173 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16174 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16175 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16178 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16179 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16180 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16181 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16182 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016184res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16185shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16186 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16187 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16188 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16189 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16190 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16191 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16192 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16193 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195 ACL derivatives :
16196 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16197 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16198 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16199 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16200 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16201 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16202 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16203 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16204
16205res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16206shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16207 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16208 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16209 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16210 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16211 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16214shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16215 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16216 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16217 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16218 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16219 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16220 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016221
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016222res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16223 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16224 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16225 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16226 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16229shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16230 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16231 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16232 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16233 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16234 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16235 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237res.ver : string
16238resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16239 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16240 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016242 ACL derivatives :
16243 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16246 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16247 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016248 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016251 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16252 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016254status : integer
16255 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16256 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16257 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016258
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016259unique-id : string
16260 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16261 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16262 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16263 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16264 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16265 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267url : string
16268 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16269 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16270 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16271 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16272 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16273 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16274 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276 ACL derivatives :
16277 url : exact string match
16278 url_beg : prefix match
16279 url_dir : subdir match
16280 url_dom : domain match
16281 url_end : suffix match
16282 url_len : length match
16283 url_reg : regex match
16284 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286url_ip : ip
16287 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16288 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16289 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16290 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16291 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16292 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16293 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295url_port : integer
16296 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16297 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16298 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16299 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016300
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016301urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16302url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16304 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016305 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16306 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16307 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16308 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016309 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16310 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016311 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16312 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016314 ACL derivatives :
16315 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16316 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16317 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16318 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16319 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16320 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16321 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16322 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016323
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016325 Example :
16326 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16327 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16328 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16329 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016330
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016331urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016332 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16333 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16334 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016335
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016336url32 : integer
16337 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16338 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16339 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16340 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16341 is an unsigned integer.
16342
16343url32+src : binary
16344 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16345 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16346 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16347
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163497.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016350---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016352Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16353every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016354order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016356ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16357---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016358FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016359HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016360HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16361HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016362HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16363HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16364HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16365HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16366LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016367METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016368METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016369METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16370METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16371METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16372METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016373METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016374METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016375RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016376REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016377TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016378WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16379---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016380
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163828. Logging
16383----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016384
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016385One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16386provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16387very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16388provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16389state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016390to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016391headers.
16392
16393In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16394about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16395send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16396
16397 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16398 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16399 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16400 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16401 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016402 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016403 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016404
16405The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16406allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16407as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16408while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16409real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16410delay.
16411
16412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164138.1. Log levels
16414---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016415
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016416TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016417source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016418HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16419in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16420track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16421syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16422about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016423
16424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164258.2. Log formats
16426----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016427
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016428HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016429and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16430slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16431options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016432
16433 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16434 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16435 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16436 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16437 extents.
16438
16439 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16440 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16441 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16442 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16443 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16444
16445 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16446 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16447 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16448 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16449 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16450
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016451 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16452 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16453 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16454 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16455
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016456 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16457
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016458Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16459specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16460field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16461servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16462always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16463identifier.
16464
16465Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16466 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16467 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16468 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16469 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16470
16471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164728.2.1. Default log format
16473-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016474
16475This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16476as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16477format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16478
16479 Example :
16480 listen www
16481 mode http
16482 log global
16483 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16484
16485 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16486 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16487 (www/HTTP)
16488
16489 Field Format Extract from the example above
16490 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16491 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16492 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16493 4 'to' to
16494 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16495 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16496
16497Detailed fields description :
16498 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16499 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16500 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16501 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16502 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16503 and processed the connection.
16504 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16505
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016506In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16507"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16508connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16509
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016510It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16511will eventually disappear.
16512
16513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165148.2.2. TCP log format
16515---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016516
16517The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16518is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16519information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16520counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16521emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16522environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16523the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16524sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016525specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16526not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16527fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16528marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016529
16530 Example :
16531 frontend fnt
16532 mode tcp
16533 option tcplog
16534 log global
16535 default_backend bck
16536
16537 backend bck
16538 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16539
16540 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16541 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16542 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16543
16544 Field Format Extract from the example above
16545 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16546 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16547 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16548 4 frontend_name fnt
16549 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16550 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16551 7 bytes_read* 212
16552 8 termination_state --
16553 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16554 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16555
16556Detailed fields description :
16557 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016558 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16559 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16560 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016561 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016562 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016563 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016564
16565 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016566 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16567 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16568 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016569
16570 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16571 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16572 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016573 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16574 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16575 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16576 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016577
16578 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16579 and processed the connection.
16580
16581 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16582 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16583 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16584 applications.
16585
16586 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16587 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16588 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16589 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16590 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16591
16592 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16593 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16594 See "Timers" below for more details.
16595
16596 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16597 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16598 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16599 "Timers" below for more details.
16600
16601 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016602 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016603 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16604 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16605 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16606 details.
16607
16608 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16609 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16610 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16611 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16612 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16613
16614 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16615 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16616 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16617 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16618 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16619 for more details.
16620
16621 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016622 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016623 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16624 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16625 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016626 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016627
16628 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16629 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16630 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16631 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16632 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16633 caused by a denial of service attack.
16634
16635 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16636 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16637 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16638 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16639 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16640 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16641 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16642 denial of service attack.
16643
16644 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16645 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16646 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16647 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16648 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16649 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16650 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16651 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16652 be processed than on other servers.
16653
16654 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16655 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16656 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16657 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16658 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16659 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16660 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16661 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16662 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16663 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16664 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16665 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16666 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16667
16668 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16669 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16670 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16671 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16672 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16673 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016674 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016675 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16676
16677 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16678 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16679 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16680 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16681 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16682 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016683 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016684 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16685 occurs.
16686
16687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166888.2.3. HTTP log format
16689----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016690
16691The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16692is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16693the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16694are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16695emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16696generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16697"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16698which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016699frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16700is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016701
16702Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16703slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16704with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16705
16706 Example :
16707 frontend http-in
16708 mode http
16709 option httplog
16710 log global
16711 default_backend bck
16712
16713 backend static
16714 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16715
16716 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16717 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16718 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016719 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016720
16721 Field Format Extract from the example above
16722 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16723 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016724 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016725 4 frontend_name http-in
16726 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016727 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016728 7 status_code 200
16729 8 bytes_read* 2750
16730 9 captured_request_cookie -
16731 10 captured_response_cookie -
16732 11 termination_state ----
16733 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16734 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16735 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16736 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16737 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016738
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016739Detailed fields description :
16740 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016741 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16742 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16743 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016744 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016745 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016746 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016747
16748 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016749 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16750 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16751 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016752
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016753 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16754 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016755
16756 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16757 and processed the connection.
16758
16759 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16760 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16761 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16762
16763 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16764 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16765 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16766 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16767 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16768 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16769
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016770 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16771 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16772 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016773 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016774 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16775 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016776 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16777 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016778
16779 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16780 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016781 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016782
16783 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16784 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016785 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16786 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016787
16788 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16789 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16790 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16791 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16792 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016793 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16794 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016795
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016796 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16797 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16798 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16799 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16800 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16801 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16802 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016803 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016804
16805 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16806 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16807 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16808
16809 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16810 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016811 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016812 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16813 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16814 overflowing.
16815
16816 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16817 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16818 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16819 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16820 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16821 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16822 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16823 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16824
16825 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16826 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16827 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16828 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16829 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16830 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16831 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16832 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16833
16834 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16835 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16836 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16837 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16838 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16839 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16840 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16841
16842 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016843 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016844 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16845 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16846 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016847 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016848 system.
16849
16850 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16851 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16852 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16853 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16854 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16855 caused by a denial of service attack.
16856
16857 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16858 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16859 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16860 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16861 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16862 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16863 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16864 denial of service attack.
16865
16866 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16867 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16868 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16869 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16870 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16871 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16872 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16873 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16874 processed than on other servers.
16875
16876 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16877 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16878 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16879 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16880 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16881 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16882 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16883 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16884 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16885 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16886 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16887 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16888 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16889
16890 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16891 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16892 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16893 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16894 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16895 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016896 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016897 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16898
16899 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16900 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16901 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16902 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16903 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16904 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016905 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016906 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16907 occurs.
16908
16909 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16910 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16911 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16912 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16913 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16914 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16915 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16916 cookies" below for more details.
16917
16918 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16919 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16920 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16921 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16922 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16923 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16924 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16925 and cookies" below for more details.
16926
16927 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16928 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16929 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16930 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16931 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16932 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16933 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16934 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16935
16936
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200169378.2.4. Custom log format
16938------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016939
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016940The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016941mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016942
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016943HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016944Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16945separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16946prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16947
16948Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16949variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016950("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016951
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016952If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016953as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016954less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16955the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16956
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016957Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016958In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016959in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016960
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016961Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16962'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16963https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16964such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16965
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016966Flags are :
16967 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016968 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016969 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16970 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016971
16972 Example:
16973
16974 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16975 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16976
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016977 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16978
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016979At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16980
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016981 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16982 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016983
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016984the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016985
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016986 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16987 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16988 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016989
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016990and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16991
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016992 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16993 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016994
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016995Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16996
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016997 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016998 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016999 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17000 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17001 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017002 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17003 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17004 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017005 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017006 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17007 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017008 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017009 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17010 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017011 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017012 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017013 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017014 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017015 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017016 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017017 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017018 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17019 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17020 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17021 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17022 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017023 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017024 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17025 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017026 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017027 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17028 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017029 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17030 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17031 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017032 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017033 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17034 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017035 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017036 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17037 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17038 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017039 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017040 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017041 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17042 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17043 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17044 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017045 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017046 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017047 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017048 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017049 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017050 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017051 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17052 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17053 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017054 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017055 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17056 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017057 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017058 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17059 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017060 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017061 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017062 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017063 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017064
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017065 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017066
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017067
170688.2.5. Error log format
17069-----------------------
17070
17071When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17072protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17073By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17074"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017075will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017076logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17077
17078The format looks like this :
17079
17080 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17081 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17082 Connection error during SSL handshake
17083
17084 Field Format Extract from the example above
17085 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17086 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17087 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17088 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17089 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17090
17091These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17092failures.
17093
17094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170958.3. Advanced logging options
17096-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017097
17098Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17099just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17100options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17101for more information about their usage.
17102
17103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17105------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017106
17107It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17108haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17109commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17110monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17111ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17112
17113 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17114 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17115 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17116 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17117
17118 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17119 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17120 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017121 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017122 such as other load-balancers.
17123
17124 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17125 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17126 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17127
17128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171298.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17130----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017131
17132The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17133what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17134or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017135"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017136just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17137log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17138after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17139is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17140with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17141with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17142
17143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171448.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17145------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017146
17147Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17148for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17149"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17150retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17151raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17152a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17153file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17154you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17155"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17156
17157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171588.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17159--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017160
17161Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17162multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17163them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17164"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17165logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17166error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17167and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17168too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17169useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17170alternative.
17171
17172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171738.4. Timing events
17174------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017175
17176Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17177reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17178the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17179frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017180mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17181addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17182
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017183Timings events in HTTP mode:
17184
17185 first request 2nd request
17186 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17187 t tr t tr ...
17188 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17189 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17190 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17191 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17192 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17193
17194Timings events in TCP mode:
17195
17196 TCP session
17197 |<----------------->|
17198 t t
17199 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17200 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17201 |<------ Tt ------->|
17202
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017203 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017204 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017205 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17206 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17207 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017208 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017209 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17210 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17211 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17212 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017213
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017214 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17215 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17216 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017217 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17218 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17219 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17220 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17221 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17222 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017223
17224 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17225 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17226 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17227 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17228 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17229 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17230 request typed by hand during a test.
17231
17232 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17233 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017234 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017235 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17236 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17237 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17238 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017239
17240 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17241 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17242 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17243 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17244 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17245
17246 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17247 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17248 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17249 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17250 connection never established.
17251
17252 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17253 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17254 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17255 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17256 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17257 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17258 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17259 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17260 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17261 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17262 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17263
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017264 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17265 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17266 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17267 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17268 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17269 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17270
17271 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17272
17273 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17274 "Ta" can never be negative.
17275
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017276 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17277 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017278 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17279 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017280 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017281
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017282 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017283
17284 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017285 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17286 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017287
17288These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17289protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17290that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017291due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17292"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17293that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017294
17295Most common cases :
17296
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017297 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17298 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17299 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17300 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17301 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17302 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17303 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17304 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17305 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17306 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17307 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017308 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017309
17310 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17311 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17312 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17313 of ms on remote networks.
17314
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017315 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17316 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17317 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017318
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017319 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17320 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17321 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17322 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17323 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17324 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17325 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17326 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17327 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017328
17329Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17330
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017331 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017332 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017333 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017334
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017335 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017336 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17337 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17338
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017339 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017340 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17341 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17342 flags.
17343
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017344 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17345 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017346 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17347 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17348 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17349 the client connection was maintained open.
17350
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017351 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017352 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017353 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017354 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17355
17356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173578.5. Session state at disconnection
17358-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017359
17360TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17361"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
173622-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17363each of which has a special meaning :
17364
17365 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17366 session to terminate :
17367
17368 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17369
17370 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17371 server explicitly refused it.
17372
17373 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17374 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17375 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17376 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017377 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017378
17379 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17380 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017381
17382 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17383 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17384 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17385 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17386 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17387
17388 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17389 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17390 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17391 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17392 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17393
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017394 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17395 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17396
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017397 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17398 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17399 backup connections when going up.
17400
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017401 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17402
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017403 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17404 send or receive data.
17405
17406 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17407 send or receive data.
17408
17409 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17410 with nothing left in the buffers.
17411
17412 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17413
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017414 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017415 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17416
17417 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17418 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17419 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17420 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17421 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17422
17423 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17424 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17425
17426 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17427 server (HTTP only).
17428
17429 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17430
17431 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17432 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17433 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17434
17435 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17436 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17437 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17438
17439 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17440
17441 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17442 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17443
17444 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17445 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17446 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17447
17448 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17449 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017450 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17451 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017452
17453 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17454 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17455 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17456 another server.
17457
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017458 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017459 server.
17460
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017461 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17462 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17463 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17464 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17465
17466 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17467 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17468 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17469 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17470
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017471 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17472 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17473 "use-server" rule).
17474
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017475 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17476
17477 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17478 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17479
17480 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17481
17482 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17483 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17484 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17485
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017486 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17487 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017488 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017489 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17490 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17491
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017492 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17493
17494 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17495 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17496
17497 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17498
17499 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17500
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017501The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17502was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017503helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17504starvation, attacks, etc...
17505
17506The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17507alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17508easier finding and understanding.
17509
17510 Flags Reason
17511
17512 -- Normal termination.
17513
17514 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17515 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17516 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17517 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17518
17519 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17520 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17521 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17522 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17523 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17524 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017525
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017526 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17527 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017528 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017529
17530 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17531 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17532 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17533
17534 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17535 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17536 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17537 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17538 the server takes too long to respond.
17539
17540 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17541 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17542 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17543 long a time to respond.
17544
17545 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17546 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17547 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17548 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017549 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17550 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017551
17552 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17553 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17554 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17555 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17556 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017557 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017558 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17559 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17560 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17561 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17562 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17563 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17564 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17565 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017566 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017567 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17568 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17569 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017570
17571 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17572 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017573 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17574 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17575 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17576 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017577
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017578 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17579 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017581 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017582 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17583 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017584 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017585 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17586 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17587
17588 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17589 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17590 503 or 504 here.
17591
17592 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17593 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17594 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17595 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17596 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17597
17598 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17599 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017600 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017601 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17602 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17603
17604 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17605 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17606 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17607 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17608 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17609 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17610 between haproxy and the server.
17611
17612 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17613 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17614 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17615 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17616 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17617 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17618 solution is to fix the application.
17619
17620 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17621 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17622 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17623 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17624 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17625 external attacks.
17626
17627 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17628 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017629 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017630 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17631 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17632
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017633 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17634 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17635 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017636 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017637 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017638
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017639 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17640 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17641 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17642 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017643 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17644 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17645 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17646 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17647 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017648
17649 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17650 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17651 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17652 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17653
17654 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17655 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17656 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17657 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17658
17659 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17660 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17661 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17662 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17663
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017664The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17665persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17666important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17667re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17668
17669 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17670
17671 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17672 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17673 set on a GET request.
17674
17675 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17676 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017677 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017678 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17679
17680 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17681 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17682 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17683
17684 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17685 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17686 already got a cookie.
17687
17688 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17689 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17690 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17691 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17692 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17693
17694 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17695 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17696 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17697
17698 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17699 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17700 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17701
17702 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17703 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17704
17705 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17706 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17707 then advertised in the response.
17708
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177108.6. Non-printable characters
17711-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017712
17713In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17714consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17715converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17716prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17717being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17718escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17719is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17720'}' when logging headers.
17721
17722Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17723issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17724containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17725
17726Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17727the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17728performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17729
17730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177318.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17732---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017733
17734Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17735achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017736section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017737cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17738the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17739the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017740locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017741not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17742user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17743a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17744wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17745
17746 Examples :
17747 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17748 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17749
17750 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17751 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17752
17753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177548.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17755---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017756
17757Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17758proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17759the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17760server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17761
17762Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17763response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017764section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017765
17766It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017767time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17768appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017769are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17770and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17771follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17772request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17773in the logs.
17774
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017775As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17776frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17777an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17778
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017779 Example :
17780 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17781 listen proxy-out
17782 mode http
17783 option httplog
17784 option logasap
17785 log global
17786 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17787
17788 # log the name of the virtual server
17789 capture request header Host len 20
17790
17791 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17792 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17793
17794 # log the beginning of the referrer
17795 capture request header Referer len 20
17796
17797 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17798 capture response header Server len 20
17799
17800 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17801 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17802
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017803 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017804 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17805
17806 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17807 capture response header Via len 20
17808
17809 # log the URL location during a redirection
17810 capture response header Location len 20
17811
17812 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17813 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17814 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17815 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17816 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17817
17818 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17819 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17820 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17821 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017822 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017823
17824 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17825 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17826 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17827 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17828 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017829 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017830
17831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178328.9. Examples of logs
17833---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017834
17835These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17836them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17837reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17838
17839 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17840 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17841 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17842
17843 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17844 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17845
17846 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17847 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17848 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17849
17850 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17851 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17852
17853 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17854 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17855 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17856
17857 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017858 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017859 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17860 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17861
17862 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17863 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17864 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17865
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017866 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17867 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17868 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17869 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17870 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17871 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017872
17873 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017874 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017875
17876 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17877 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17878 Nothing was sent to any server.
17879
17880 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17881 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17882
17883 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17884 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017885 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017886 send a 408 return code to the client.
17887
17888 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17889 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17890
17891 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17892 5 seconds ("c----").
17893
17894 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17895 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017896 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017897
17898 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017899 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017900 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17901 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17902 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17903 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17904 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017905
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017906
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200179079. Supported filters
17908--------------------
17909
17910Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17911accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17912unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17913
17914See also : "filter"
17915
179169.1. Trace
17917----------
17918
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017919filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017920
17921 Arguments:
17922 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17923 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17924
17925 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17926 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17927 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17928 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17929
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017930 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017931 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17932 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17933 amount of the parsed data.
17934
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017935 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017936
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017937This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17938callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17939information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17940filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17941
17942Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17943tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17944a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17945
17946
179479.2. HTTP compression
17948---------------------
17949
17950filter compression
17951
17952The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17953keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017954when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
17955fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
17956done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
17957explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
17958filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
17959listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17960order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017961
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017962See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
17963 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017964
17965
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179669.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17967--------------------------------------------
17968
17969filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17970
17971 Arguments :
17972
17973 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17974 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17975 parsed.
17976
17977 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17978 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17979 part must be placed in its own scope.
17980
17981The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17982external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017983streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017984exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17985also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17986
17987SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17988the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17989
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017990For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017991"doc/SPOE.txt".
17992
17993Important note:
17994 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17995 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17996
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179979.4. Cache
17998----------
17999
18000filter cache <name>
18001
18002 Arguments :
18003
18004 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18005
18006The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18007"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018008cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018009other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18010case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18011is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18012filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018013listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18014order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018015
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018016See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18017 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18018
18019
180209.5. Fcgi-app
18021-------------
18022
18023filter fcg-app <name>
18024
18025 Arguments :
18026
18027 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18028
18029The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18030request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18031reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18032used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18033implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18034used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18035fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18036used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18037order.
18038
18039See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18040 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18041
18042
1804310. FastCGI applications
18044-------------------------
18045
18046HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18047feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18048the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18049FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18050servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18051FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18052backend.
18053
18054HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18055application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18056connection.
18057
1805810.1. Setup
18059-----------
18060
1806110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18062--------------------------
18063
18064fcgi-app <name>
18065 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18066 document root must be defined.
18067
18068acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18069 Declare or complete an access list.
18070
18071 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18072 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18073 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18074 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18075 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18076
18077docroot <path>
18078 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18079 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18080 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18081
18082index <script-name>
18083 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18084 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18085 is an optional setting.
18086
18087 Example :
18088 index index.php
18089
18090log-stderr global
18091log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18092 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18093 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18094
18095 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18096 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18097
18098pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18099 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18100 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18101 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18102
18103 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18104 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18105 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18106 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18107
18108 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18109 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18110
18111path-info <regex>
18112 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18113 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18114 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18115 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18116 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18117
18118 Example :
18119 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18120
18121option get-values
18122no option get-values
18123 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18124
18125 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18126 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18127
18128 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18129 application will accept.
18130
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018131 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18132 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018133
18134 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18135 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18136 option is disabled.
18137
18138 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18139 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18140 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18141 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18142 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18143 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18144
18145option keep-conn
18146no option keep-conn
18147 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18148 sending a response.
18149
18150 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18151 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18152
18153option max-reqs <reqs>
18154 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18155 accept.
18156
18157 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18158 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18159 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18160 to 1.
18161
18162option mpxs-conns
18163no option mpxs-conns
18164 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18165
18166 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18167 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18168
18169set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18170 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18171 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18172 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18173 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18174
18175 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18176 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18177 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18178
18179 Example :
18180 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18181 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18182
18183 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18184
18185
1818610.1.2. Proxy section
18187---------------------
18188
18189use-fcgi-app <name>
18190 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18191
18192 Arguments :
18193 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18194
18195 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18196 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18197 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18198 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18199 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18200
18201 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18202 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18203 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18204 application are evaluated.
18205
18206
1820710.1.3. Example
18208---------------
18209
18210 frontend front-http
18211 mode http
18212 bind *:80
18213 bind *:
18214
18215 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18216 default_backend back-static
18217
18218 backend back-static
18219 mode http
18220 server www A.B.C.D:80
18221
18222 backend back-dynamic
18223 mode http
18224 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18225 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18226
18227 fcgi-app php-fpm
18228 log-stderr global
18229 option keep-conn
18230
18231 docroot /var/www/my-app
18232 index index.php
18233 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18234
18235
1823610.2. Default parameters
18237------------------------
18238
18239A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18240the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18241scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18242applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18243
18244 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18245 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18246 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18247 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18248 | | |
18249 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18250 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18251 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18252 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18253 | | application. |
18254 | | |
18255 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18256 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18257 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18258 | | |
18259 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18260 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18261 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18262 | | the application's configuration. |
18263 | | |
18264 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18265 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18266 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18267 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18268 | | |
18269 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18270 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18271 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18272 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18273 | | be defined. |
18274 | | |
18275 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18276 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18277 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18278 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18279 | | is not set too. |
18280 | | |
18281 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18282 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18283 | | set. |
18284 | | |
18285 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18286 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18287 | | the request. |
18288 | | |
18289 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18290 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18291 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18292 | | |
18293 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18294 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18295 | | script to process the request. |
18296 | | |
18297 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18298 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18299 | | |
18300 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18301 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18302 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18303 | | |
18304 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18305 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18306 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18307 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18308 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18309 | | |
18310 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18311 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18312 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18313 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18314 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18315 | | side. |
18316 | | |
18317 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18318 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18319 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18320 | | connected to. |
18321 | | |
18322 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18323 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18324 | | |
18325 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18326 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18327 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18328 | | |
18329 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18330
18331
1833210.3. Limitations
18333------------------
18334
18335The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18336way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18337during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18338establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18339application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18340or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18341message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18342these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18343and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18344
18345Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18346request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18347requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18348
18349About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18350into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18351fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18352"http-request" ones.
18353
18354Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18355FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18356processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18357must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18358here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018360/*
18361 * Local variables:
18362 * fill-column: 79
18363 * End:
18364 */